blob: b739df7c0813b8ea7e958cab13e46bac30ff2ad3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf2e08332021-11-23 15:40:21 +01007 2021/11/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600616quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600695that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600700Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
701if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
702or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
703
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
706 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
707
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100708When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
709double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600710and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100711a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
712a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
713the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
714regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
715around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
716more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200717
718
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007192.3. Environment variables
720--------------------------
721
722HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
723interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
724configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
725optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
726shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200727underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
728list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
729arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100730before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
731use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
732next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
733existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200734
735 Example:
736
737 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
738
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100739 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
742
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
744file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200745
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200746* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
747 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
748
749* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
750 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
751 directory.
752
753* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
754
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500755* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200756 processes, separated by semicolons.
757
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500758* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759 CLI, separated by semicolons.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200817Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
818See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
819
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200820The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
821expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100823 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
824 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200826 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530827 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
828 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200829 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
830 from left to right until one returns false
831 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
832 from right to left until one returns true
833
834Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
835operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836
837The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
838
839 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
840 exists, regardless of its contents
841
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200842 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
843 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
844 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
845
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200846 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
847 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
848
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200849 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
850 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
851 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
852 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
853
854 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
855 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
856 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
857 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
858
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200859Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100860
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200861 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
862 listen mwcli_px
863 bind :1111
864 ...
865 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200867 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
868 bind :80
869 .endif
870
871 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200872 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200873 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200874 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200875 .endif
876
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200877 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200878 bind :443 ssl crt ...
879 .endif
880
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200881 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
882 profiling.memory on
883 .endif
884
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200885 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
886 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
887 .endif
888
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200889Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100892 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
893 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
894 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
895
896Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
897"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
898fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
899provide advice to the user.
900
901Example:
902
903 .if "${A}"
904 .if "${B}"
905 .notice "A=1, B=1"
906 .elif "${C}"
907 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
908 .elif "${D}"
909 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
910 .else
911 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
912 .endif
913 .else
914 .notice "A=0"
915 .endif
916
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200917 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
918 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
919
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100920
9212.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922----------------
923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100924Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100925values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
926otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
927numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
928for every keyword. Supported units are :
929
930 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
931 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
932 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
933 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
934 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
935 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
936
937
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009382.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200939-------------
940
941 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
942 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
943 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
944 global
945 daemon
946 maxconn 256
947
948 defaults
949 mode http
950 timeout connect 5000ms
951 timeout client 50000ms
952 timeout server 50000ms
953
954 frontend http-in
955 bind *:80
956 default_backend servers
957
958 backend servers
959 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
960
961
962 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
963 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 listen http-in
975 bind *:80
976 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
977
978
979Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
980
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100981 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200982
983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985--------------------
986
987Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
988are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
989of them have command-line equivalents.
990
991The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
992
993 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200994 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001008 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001010 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001011 - h1-case-adjust
1012 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001013 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001014 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001015 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001016 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001017 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001020 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001021 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001022 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001023 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001024 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001025 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001027 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001029 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001030 - presetenv
1031 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032 - uid
1033 - ulimit-n
1034 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001035 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001036 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001038 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001040 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001041 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - ssl-default-bind-options
1043 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001044 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-server-options
1046 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001047 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001048 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001049 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001050 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001051 - 51degrees-data-file
1052 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001053 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001054 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001055 - wurfl-data-file
1056 - wurfl-information-list
1057 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001058 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001059 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001062 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001063 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001065 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001066 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001067 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001068 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001069 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001070 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001071 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073 - noepoll
1074 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001075 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001077 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001078 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001079 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001080 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001081 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001082 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001083 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001084 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001085 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001086 - tune.buffers.limit
1087 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001088 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001089 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001090 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001091 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001092 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001093 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001094 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001095 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001096 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001097 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001098 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001099 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001100 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001103 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001104 - tune.maxaccept
1105 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001106 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001107 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001108 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001109 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1110 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001111 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1112 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001113 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001114 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001115 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001116 - tune.sndbuf.client
1117 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001118 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001119 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001120 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001121 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001123 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001125 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1126 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001128 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001129 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1130 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1131 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001132 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1133 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001137 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
1139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011403.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141------------------------------------
1142
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001143ca-base <dir>
1144 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001145 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1146 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1147 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149chroot <jail dir>
1150 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1151 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1152 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1153 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1154 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001155 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001156
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001157cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001158 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001159 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1160 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1161 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1162 set. These sets have the format
1163
1164 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1165
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001166 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1167 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001168 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001169 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001170 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1171 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001172 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1173 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1174 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1175 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1176 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1177 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1178 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1179 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1180 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1181 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001182
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001183 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1184 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1185 on the machine's word size.
1186
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001187 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1189 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1190 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1191 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1192 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1193 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001194
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001195 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1196 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1197 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1198 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001199
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1202 # first 4 CPUs
1203
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001204 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1205 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001206 # word size.
1207
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001208 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1209 # and so on.
1210 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1211 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1212 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1213
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001214 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1215 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1216 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1217 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001218
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001219 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1221 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001222
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001223crt-base <dir>
1224 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001225 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1226 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001228daemon
1229 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1230 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001231 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1232 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001233
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001234default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001235 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001236 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1237 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1238 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1239 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1240 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1241 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1242 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1243 not start with a slash ('/'):
1244 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1245 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1246
1247 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1248 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1249 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1250 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1251 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1252 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1253 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1254 each of them.
1255
1256 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1257 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1258 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1259 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1260 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1261 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1262 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1263 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1264
1265 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1266 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001267 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001268 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1269 made easily relocatable.
1270
1271 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1272 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1273 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1274 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1275 consistent across all configuration files.
1276
1277 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1278 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1279 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1280 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1281 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1282 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1283 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1284 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1285
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001286deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1287 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001288 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001289
1290deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001291 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001292 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1293
1294deviceatlas-separator <char>
1295 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1296 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1297
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001298deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001299 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1300 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1301 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001302
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001303expose-experimental-directives
1304 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1305 the config file will be rejected.
1306
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001307external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001308 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1309 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001310 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1311 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1312 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1313 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1314 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001316gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001317 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001318 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1319 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001320 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001321 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001323
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001324grace <time>
1325 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1326
1327 Arguments :
1328 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1329 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1330 soft-stop operation.
1331
1332 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1333 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1334 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1335 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1336 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1337 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1338 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1339 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1340 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1341
1342 Example:
1343
1344 global
1345 grace 10s
1346
1347 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1348 frontend ext-check
1349 bind :9999
1350 monitor-uri /ext-check
1351 monitor fail if { stopping }
1352
1353 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1354 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1355 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1356 SIGUSR1 signal.
1357
1358 Example:
1359
1360 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1361 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1362 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1363 frontend ext-check
1364 bind :9999
1365 monitor-uri /ext-check
1366 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1367
1368 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1369
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001370group <group name>
1371 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1372 See also "gid" and "user".
1373
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001374hard-stop-after <time>
1375 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1376
1377 Arguments :
1378 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1379 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1380 SIGUSR1 signal.
1381
1382 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1383 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1384 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1385
1386 Example:
1387 global
1388 hard-stop-after 30s
1389
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001390 See also: grace
1391
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001392h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1393 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1394 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1395 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1396 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001397 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001398 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1399 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1400 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1401 specified in a proxy.
1402
1403 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1404 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1405 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1406 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1407 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1408 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1409 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1410
1411 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1412 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1413 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1414 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1415 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1416
1417 Example:
1418 global
1419 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1420
1421 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1422 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1423
1424h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1425 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1426 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1427 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1428 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1429 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1430 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1431 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1432 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1433
1434 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1435 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1436 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1437
1438 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1439 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1440
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001441insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001442 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001443 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1444 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1445 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1446 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1447 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1448 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1449 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001451 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1452 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1453 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1454 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1455 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1456 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1457 disable it.
1458
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001459insecure-setuid-wanted
1460 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1461 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1462 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1463 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001464 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001465 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001466 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001467 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1468 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001469 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001470 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1471 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1472 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1473 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1474
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001475issuers-chain-path <dir>
1476 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1477 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1478 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001479 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001480 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1481 "issuers-chain-path".
1482 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1483 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1484 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1485 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1486 will share the chain in memory.
1487
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001488h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1489 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1490 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1491 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1492 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1493 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1494 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1495 the keyword with "no'.
1496
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001497localpeer <name>
1498 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1499 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1500 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1501 the configuration parsing.
1502
1503 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1504 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1505
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001506log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001507 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001508 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001509 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001510 configured with "log global".
1511
1512 <address> can be one of:
1513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001514 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1516 port).
1517
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001518 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1519 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1520 port).
1521
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001522 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001523 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1524 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001526
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001527 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1528 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1529 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1530 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1531 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1532 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1533 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1534 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1535 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1536 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001537 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001538 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1539 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1540 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001541 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1542 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001543
1544 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1545 "fd@2", see above.
1546
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001547 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1548 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1549 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1550 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1551 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1552
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001553 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1554 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001555
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001556 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1557 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1558 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1559 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1560 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1561 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1562 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1563 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1564 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1565 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001566 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1567 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001568
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001569 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1570 one of the following :
1571
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001572 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1573 field is stripped. This is the default.
1574 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1575 rfc3164.
1576
1577 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1579
1580 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1581 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1582
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001583 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1584 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1585 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1586 designed to be used with a local log server.
1587
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001588 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1589 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1590 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1591 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1592 logger consumes.
1593
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001594 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1595 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1596 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1597 used with a local log server.
1598
1599 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1600 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1601 designed to be used with a local log server.
1602
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001603 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1604 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1605 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1606 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1607
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001608 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1609 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1610 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1611 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1612 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1613
1614 <sample_size>
1615 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1616 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1617 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1618 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1619 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1620
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001621 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001622
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001623 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1624 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1625 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1626
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001627 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1628 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1629 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1630 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631
1632 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001633 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1634 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1635 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1636 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1637 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1638 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001640 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001641
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001642log-send-hostname [<string>]
1643 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1644 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1645 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1646 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1647 the logs.
1648
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001649log-tag <string>
1650 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1651 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1652 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001653 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001654
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001655lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001656 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1657 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1658 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1659 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1660 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1661 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001662 used multiple times.
1663
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001664lua-load-per-thread <file>
1665 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1666 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1667 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1668 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1669 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1670 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1671 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1672 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1673 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1674 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1675 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1676 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1677 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1678 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1679 times.
1680
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001681lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1682 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1683 variable.
1684 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1685 to "path".
1686
1687 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1688 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1689 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1690 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1691 will be checked earlier.
1692
1693 As an example by specifying the following path:
1694
1695 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1696 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1697
1698 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1699 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1700 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1701 paths if that does not exist either.
1702
1703 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1704 documentation.
1705
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001706master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001707 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1708 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1709 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001710 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001711 or daemon mode.
1712
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001713 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1714 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1715 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1716 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1717 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001719 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001720
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001721mworker-max-reloads <number>
1722 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001723 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001724 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1725 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1726 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1727
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001728nbthread <number>
1729 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001730 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1731 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1732 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1733 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1734 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1735 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1736 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001737
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001738numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001739 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1740 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1741 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1742 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1743 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1744 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1745 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1746 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1747 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1748 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001750pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001751 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1752 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1753 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1754 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001755
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001756pp2-never-send-local
1757 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1758 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1759 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1760 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1761 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1762 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1763 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1764 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1765 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1766 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1767 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1768
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001769presetenv <name> <value>
1770 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1771 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1772 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1773 and "unsetenv".
1774
1775resetenv [<name> ...]
1776 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1777 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1778 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1779 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1780 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1781 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1782 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1783 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1784
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001785stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001786 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1787 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1788 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001789
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001790server-state-base <directory>
1791 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001792 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1793 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001794
1795server-state-file <file>
1796 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1797 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1798 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1799 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1800 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1801 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1802 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1803 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001804 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1805 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001806
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001807set-var <var-name> <expr>
1808 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1809 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1810 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1811 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1812 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1813 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001814 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001815 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1816 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1817
1818 Example:
1819 global
1820 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1821 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1822 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1823
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001824set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1825 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1826 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1827 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1828 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1829 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1830 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1831 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1832 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1833 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1834 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1835
1836 Example:
1837 global
1838 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1839 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1840
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001841setenv <name> <value>
1842 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1843 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1844 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1845 and "unsetenv".
1846
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001847set-dumpable
1848 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001849 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1850 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1851 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1852 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1853 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1854 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1855 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1856 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1857 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1858 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1859 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1860 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1861 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1862 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1863 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001864 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001865 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001867ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1869 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001870 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001871 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001872 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1873 information and recommendations see e.g.
1874 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1875 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1876 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1877 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001878
1879ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1881 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1882 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1883 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1884 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001885 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1886 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1887 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001888 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001889
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001890ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1892 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1893 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1894 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1895 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1896
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001897ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1899 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1900 keyword to see available options.
1901
1902 Example:
1903 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001904 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001905
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001906ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1908 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001909 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001910 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001911 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1912 information and recommendations see e.g.
1913 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1914 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1915 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1916 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1917 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001918
1919ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1921 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1922 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1923 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1924 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001925 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1926 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1927 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1928 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001929
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001930ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1932 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1933 keyword to see available options.
1934
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001935ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1937 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1938 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001939 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001940 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001941 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1942 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1943 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1944 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001945 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1946 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1947 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1948
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001949ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1950 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1951 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001952 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001953 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001954 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1955
1956 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001957
1958 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1959 and won't try to remove them.
1960
1961 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1962
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001963ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001964 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001965 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1966 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1967 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001968
1969 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1970 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1971 optimize the startup time.
1972
1973 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1974 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1975 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1976
1977 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001978 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001979
1980 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001981 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1982 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983
1984 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1985 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1986 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1987 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1988 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001989 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001990
1991 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001992 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001993 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1994 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1995 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1996 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1997 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001998 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001999
2000 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2001
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002002 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002003 a cert bundle.
2004
2005 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2006 separately in several "crt".
2007
2008 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2009 since files are loading separately.
2010
2011 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2012 required to commit them.
2013
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002014 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002015 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002016
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002017 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2018 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2019 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002020
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002021 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2022 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2023 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002024
2025 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002026 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2027 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002028
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002029 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2030 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2031
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002032 The default behavior is "all".
2033
2034 Example:
2035 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2036 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2037 ssl-load-extra-files none
2038
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002039 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2040 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002041
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002042ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2043 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2044 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2045 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2046
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002047ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002048 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002049 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2050 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2051 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2052 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2053 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2054 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002055 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002056
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002057stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2058 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2059 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2060 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002061 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002062 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002064 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2065 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2066 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002067
2068stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2069 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2070 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002071 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002072
2073stats maxconn <connections>
2074 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2075 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2076
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002077thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2078 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2079 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2080 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2081 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2082 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2083 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2084 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2085 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2086 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2087
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002088thread-groups <number>
2089 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2090 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2091 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2092
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002093uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002094 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002095 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2096 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2097 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2098
2099ulimit-n <number>
2100 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2101 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2102 option.
2103
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002104 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2105 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2106 manually specify this value.
2107
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002108unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2109 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2110
2111 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2112 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2113 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2114 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2115 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002116 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002117 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2118 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2119 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2120 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2121
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002122unsetenv [<name> ...]
2123 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2124 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2125 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2126 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2127 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2128 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2129 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002131user <user name>
2132 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2133 See also "uid" and "group".
2134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002135node <name>
2136 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2137
2138 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2139 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2140 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2141 traffic.
2142
2143description <text>
2144 Add a text that describes the instance.
2145
2146 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2147 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2148 "<" and ">" characters.
2149
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100215051degrees-data-file <file path>
2151 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002152 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002153
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002154 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002155 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2156
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000215751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002158 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2159 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2160 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2161
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002162 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002163 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2164
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200216551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002166 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2167 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002169 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002170 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2171
217251degrees-cache-size <number>
2173 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2174 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2175 By default, this cache is disabled.
2176
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002177 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002178 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2179
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002180wurfl-data-file <file path>
2181 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2182 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2183
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002184 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002185 with USE_WURFL=1.
2186
2187wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2188 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2189 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2190 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2191
2192 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2193
2194 Valid WURFL properties are:
2195 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2196
2197 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2198 device.
2199
2200 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2201 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2202
2203 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2204 particular web request.
2205
2206 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2207 used Libwurfl API version.
2208
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002209 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2210 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2211
2212 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2213 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2214
2215 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2216
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002217 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002218 with USE_WURFL=1.
2219
2220wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2221 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2222 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2223
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002224 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002225 with USE_WURFL=1.
2226
2227wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2228 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2229 thus before the chroot.
2230
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002231 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002232 with USE_WURFL=1.
2233
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002234wurfl-cache-size <size>
2235 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2236 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002237 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002238 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002239
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002240 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002241 with USE_WURFL=1.
2242
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002243strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002244 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002245 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2246 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002247 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002248 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022503.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002251-----------------------
2252
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002253busy-polling
2254 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2255 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2256 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2257 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2258 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2259 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2260 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2261 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2262 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2263 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2264 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2265 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2266 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2267 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2268 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2269 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2270 "poll" pollers.
2271
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002272 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2273 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2274 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2275
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002276max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002277 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002278 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2279 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2280 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2281 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2282 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2283 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2284 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2285
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002286maxconn <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2288 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2289 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002290 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2291 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2292 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2293 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002294 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2295 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2296 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2297 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2298 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2299 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002301maxconnrate <number>
2302 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2303 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2304 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2305 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2306 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2307 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2308 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2309 fairness.
2310
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002311maxcomprate <number>
2312 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002314 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2315 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2316 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002317 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002318 default value.
2319
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002320maxcompcpuusage <number>
2321 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2322 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2323 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002324 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2325 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2326 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2327 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002328
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002329maxpipes <number>
2330 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2331 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2332 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2333 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2334 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2335 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2336
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002337maxsessrate <number>
2338 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2339 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2340 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2341 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2342 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2343 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2344 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2345 fairness.
2346
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002347maxsslconn <number>
2348 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2349 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2350 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2351 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2352 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2353 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2354 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002355 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2356 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2357 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2358 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002359 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002360 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2361 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002362
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002363maxsslrate <number>
2364 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2365 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2366 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2367 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2368 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2369 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2370 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2371 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2372 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2373 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2374
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002375maxzlibmem <number>
2376 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2377 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2378 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002379 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2380 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2381 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2382
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002383noepoll
2384 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2385 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002386 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002387
2388nokqueue
2389 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2390 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2391 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2392
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002393noevports
2394 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2395 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2396 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2397 also "nopoll".
2398
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002399nopoll
2400 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2401 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002402 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002403 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2404 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002405
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002406nosplice
2407 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002408 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002409 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002410 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002411 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2412 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2413 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2414 "option splice-response".
2415
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002416nogetaddrinfo
2417 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2418 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2419
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002420noreuseport
2421 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2422 command line argument "-dR".
2423
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002424profiling.memory { on | off }
2425 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2426 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2427 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2428 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2429 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2430 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2431 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2432 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2433 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2434
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002435profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2436 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2437 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2438 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2439 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002440 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002441 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2442 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2443 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2444 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2445
2446 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2447 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2448 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2449 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2450 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002451 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2452 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2453 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2454 CLI.
2455
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002456spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002457 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2458 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2459 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2460 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2461 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2462 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002464ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002465 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002466 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002467 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002468 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002469 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2470 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2471 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002472 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2473 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002474 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2475 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2476 openssl configuration file uses:
2477 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2478
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002479ssl-mode-async
2480 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002481 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002482 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2483 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002484 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002485 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002486 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002487
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002488tune.buffers.limit <number>
2489 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2490 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2491 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2492 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2493 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002494 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002495 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2496 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2497 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2498 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2499 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2500 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2501 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2502 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002503 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002504
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002505tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2506 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2507 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2508 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002509 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002510
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002511tune.bufsize <number>
2512 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2513 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2514 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2515 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2516 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2517 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2518 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002519 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2520 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002521 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002522 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002523 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002524 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2525 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002526
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002527tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2528 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2529 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2530 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2531 this value. The default value is 1.
2532
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002533tune.fail-alloc
2534 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2535 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2536 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2537 gracefully.
2538
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002539tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2540 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2541 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2542 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2543 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2544 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2545
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002546tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2547 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2548 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2549 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2550 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2551 change it.
2552
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002553tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2554 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002555 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002557 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2558 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2559 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2560 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2561 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2562
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002563tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2564 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2565 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2566 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2567 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2568 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002569 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002570 recommended not to change this value.
2571
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002572tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002573 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002574 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002575 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002576 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2577 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2578 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2579 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2580
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002581tune.http.cookielen <number>
2582 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2583 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2584 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2585 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2586 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2587 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2588 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2589 to change this value.
2590
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002591tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2593 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002594 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002595 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002596 configuration directives too.
2597 The default value is 1024.
2598
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002599tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2600 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2601 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2602 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2603 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2604 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2605 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002606 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2607 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2608 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002609
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002610tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2611 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2612 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2613 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2614 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2615 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2616 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002617 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2618 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2619 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2620 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2621 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002622
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002623tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002624 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002625 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2626 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2627 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2628 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002629 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002630 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002631 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002632 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2633
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002634tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2635 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2636 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2637 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2638 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2639 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2640 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2641 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2642 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2643 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2644
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002645tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2646 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002647 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002648 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2649 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002650 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002651 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2652 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2653
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002654tune.lua.maxmem
2655 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2656 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2657 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2658 memory.
2659
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002660tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2661 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002662 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2663 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002664 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002665
2666tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2667 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2668 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2669 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2670 check servers.
2671
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002672tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2673 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2674 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2675 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002676 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002677
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002678tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002679 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2680 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002681 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2682 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2683 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2684 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2685 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2686 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2687 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2688 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2689 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002690
2691tune.maxpollevents <number>
2692 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2693 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2694 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2695 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2696 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2697
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002698tune.maxrewrite <number>
2699 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2700 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2701 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2702 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2703 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2704 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2705 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2706 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2707 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2708 bufsize.
2709
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002710tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2711 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2712 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2713 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2714 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2715 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2716 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2717 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2718 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2719 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002720 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2721 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002722 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2723 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2724 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2725 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2726 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2727 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2728 setting this parameter to 0.
2729
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002730tune.pipesize <number>
2731 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2732 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2733 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2734 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2735 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2736 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2737
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002738tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2739 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002740 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002741 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2742 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2743 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2744 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002745 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002746
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002747tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2748 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002749 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002750 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2751 default is 20.
2752
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002753tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2754tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2755 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2756 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2757 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002758 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002759 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002760 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2761 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2762
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002763tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002764 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002765 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2766 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2767 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2768 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2769
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002770tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002771 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002772 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2773 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2774 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2775 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2776 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2777 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2778 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002779
2780tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2781 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002782 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002783 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2784 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2785 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2786 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2787 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2788 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2789 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002790
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002791tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2792tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2793 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2794 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2795 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002796 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002797 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002798 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2799 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2800 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2801 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002802 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002803
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002804tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002805 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002806 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2807 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2808 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2809 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2810 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2811 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2812 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2813 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2814 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002815 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2816 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002817
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002818tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002819 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002820 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2821 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2822 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2823 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2824 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2825
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002826tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2827 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2828 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2829 performances. This is disabled by default.
2830
2831 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2832 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2833
2834 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2835
2836 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2837
2838 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2839
2840 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2841 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2842 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2843
2844 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2845 converted.
2846
2847 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2848 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2849 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2850 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2851 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2852 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2853 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002854 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2855 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002856
2857 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2858
2859 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2860 only need this line:
2861
2862 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2863
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002864tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2865 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002866 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002867 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2868 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2869 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2870 being used for too long.
2871
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002872tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2873 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2874 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2875 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2876 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2877 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2878 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2879 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2880 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2881 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2882 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002883 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002884 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002885
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002886tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2887 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2888 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2889 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2890 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002891 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002892 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2893 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002894 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2895 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002896
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002897tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2898 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2899 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2900 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2901 1000 entries.
2902
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002903tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2904tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002905 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2906 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2907 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2908 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002909
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002910tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002911tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002912tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2913tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2914tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002915 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2916 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2917 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2918 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2919 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2920 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2921 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2922 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002923
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002924 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2925 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2926 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2927 all available space is consumed.
2928 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2929 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2930 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002931
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002932tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2933 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002934 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002935 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002936 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002937 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2938
2939tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2940 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2941 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002942 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2943 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029453.3. Debugging
2946--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002948quiet
2949 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2950 line argument "-q".
2951
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002952zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002953 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002954 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2955 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2956 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2957 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2958 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2959
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029613.4. Userlists
2962--------------
2963It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2964http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2965it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2966
2967userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002968 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002969 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2970
2971group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002972 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002973 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2974 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2975
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002976user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2977 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002978 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2979 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002980 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2981 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2982 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2983 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002984
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002985 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2986 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2987 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2988 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2989 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2990 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2991 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002992 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002993 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002994
2995 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002996 userlist L1
2997 group G1 users tiger,scott
2998 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002999
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003000 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3001 user scott insecure-password elgato
3002 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003003
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003004 userlist L2
3005 group G1
3006 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003008 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3009 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3010 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003011
3012 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003013
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014
30153.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003016----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003017It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003018several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003019instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003020values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3021type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3022values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3023active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3024switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3025present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3026watch it.
3027
3028Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3029known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3030the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3031process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3032during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3033tables.
3034
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003035Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3036that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3037each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003038
3039peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003040 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003041 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3042
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003043bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3044 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3045 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3046
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003047disabled
3048 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3049 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3050 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3051
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003052default-bind [param*]
3053 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3054
3055default-server [param*]
3056 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3057
3058 Arguments:
3059 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3060 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3061 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3062 details.
3063
3064
3065 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3066
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003067enabled
3068 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3069 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003070
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003071log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003072 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3073 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3074 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3075 more details.
3076
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003077peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003078 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3079 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003080 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003081 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003082 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3083 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3084 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003085
3086 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3087 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3088
3089 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003090 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3091 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3092 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003093
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003094 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3095 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003096
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003097 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3098 "server" keyword explanation below).
3099
3100server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003101 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003102 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3103 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3104 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3105 of this "peers" section).
3106 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3107
3108
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003109 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003110 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003111 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003112 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3113 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3114 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003115
3116 backend mybackend
3117 mode tcp
3118 balance roundrobin
3119 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3120 stick on src
3121
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003122 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3123 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003124
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003125 Example:
3126 peers mypeers
3127 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3128 default-server ssl verify none
3129 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3130 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003131
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003132
3133table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3134 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3135
3136 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3137 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003138 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003139 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3140 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3141 "stick-table" keyword).
3142
3143 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3144 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3145 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3146 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3147 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3148 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3149 of the stick-table name as follows:
3150
3151 peers mypeers
3152 peer A ...
3153 peer B ...
3154 table t1 ...
3155
3156 frontend fe1
3157 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3158
3159 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3160 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3161
3162 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3163 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3164 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3165 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3166 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3167 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3168 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3169
3170 peers mypeers
3171 peer A ...
3172 peer B ...
3173 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3174
3175 backend t1
3176 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3177
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003178 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003179 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3180 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3181
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031823.6. Mailers
3183------------
3184It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3185If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3186in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3187
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003188mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003189 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3190 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3191
3192mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3193 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3194
3195 Example:
3196 mailers mymailers
3197 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3198 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3199
3200 backend mybackend
3201 mode tcp
3202 balance roundrobin
3203
3204 email-alert mailers mymailers
3205 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3206 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3207
3208 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3209 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3210
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003211timeout mail <time>
3212 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3213 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3214 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3215 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3216
3217 Example:
3218 mailers mymailers
3219 timeout mail 20s
3220 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003221
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020032223.7. Programs
3223-------------
3224In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3225master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3226managed the same way as the workers.
3227
3228During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3229sequence as a worker:
3230
3231 - the master is re-executed
3232 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3233 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3234 instance of the program
3235
3236During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3237
3238program <name>
3239 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3240 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3241 the management guide).
3242
3243command <command> [arguments*]
3244 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3245 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3246 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3247 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3248
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003249user <user name>
3250 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3251 See also "group".
3252
3253group <group name>
3254 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3255 See also "user".
3256
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003257option start-on-reload
3258no option start-on-reload
3259 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3260 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3261 program section.
3262
3263
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032643.8. HTTP-errors
3265----------------
3266
3267It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3268imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3269several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3270
3271http-errors <name>
3272 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3273 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3274
3275errorfile <code> <file>
3276 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3277
3278 Arguments :
3279 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003280 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003281 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003282
3283 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3284 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3285 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3286 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3287 before any chroot is performed.
3288
3289 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3290
3291 Example:
3292 http-errors website-1
3293 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3294 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3295 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3296
3297 http-errors website-2
3298 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3299 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3300 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3301
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020033023.9. Rings
3303----------
3304
3305It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3306servers or traces.
3307
3308ring <ringname>
3309 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3310
3311description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003312 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003313 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3314
3315format <format>
3316 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3317
3318 Arguments:
3319 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3320 one of the following :
3321
3322 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3323 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3324 designed to be used with a local log server.
3325
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003326 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3327 field is stripped. This is the default.
3328 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3329 rfc3164.
3330
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003331 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3332 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3333 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3334 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3335 is the default.
3336
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003337 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003338 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3339
3340 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3341 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3342
3343 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3344 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3345 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3346 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3347 logger consumes.
3348
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003349 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3350 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3351 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3352 with a local log server.
3353
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003354 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3355 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3356 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3357 used with a local log server.
3358
3359maxlen <length>
3360 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3361 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3362 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3363
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003364server <name> <address> [param*]
3365 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3366 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3367 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3368 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3369 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3370 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3371 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3372 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3373 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003374 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3375 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003376
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003377size <size>
3378 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3379 set to BUFSIZE.
3380
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003381timeout connect <timeout>
3382 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3383
3384 Arguments :
3385 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3387 as explained at the top of this document.
3388
3389timeout server <timeout>
3390 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3391
3392 Arguments :
3393 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3395 as explained at the top of this document.
3396
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003397 Example:
3398 global
3399 log ring@myring local7
3400
3401 ring myring
3402 description "My local buffer"
3403 format rfc3164
3404 maxlen 1200
3405 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003406 timeout connect 5s
3407 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003408 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003409
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020034103.10. Log forwarding
3411-------------------
3412
3413It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415
3416log-forward <name>
3417 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3418
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003419backlog <conns>
3420 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3421 on connections accept.
3422
3423bind <addr> [param*]
3424 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003425 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3426 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3427 syslog protocol over TCP.
3428 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003429 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3430
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003431dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003432 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3433 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3434 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3435 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003436 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003437
3438log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003439log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003440 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3441 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3442 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003443 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003444 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3445 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3446 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003447 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003448
3449 Example:
3450 global
3451 log stderr format iso local7
3452
3453 ring myring
3454 description "My local buffer"
3455 format rfc5424
3456 maxlen 1200
3457 size 32764
3458 timeout connect 5s
3459 timeout server 10s
3460 # syslog tcp server
3461 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3462
3463 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003464 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3465 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003466 # all messages on stderr
3467 log global
3468 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3469 log ring@myring local0
3470 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3471 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3472 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3473 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3474 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003475
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003476maxconn <conns>
3477 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3478 10 is the default.
3479
3480timeout client <timeout>
3481 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003484----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003486Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003487 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3488 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3489 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3490 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003491
3492A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3493connections.
3494
3495A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3496to forward incoming connections.
3497
3498A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3499parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3500
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003501A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3502ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3503sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3504the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3505explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3506from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3507"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3508for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3509to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3510optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3511are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3512any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3513names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3514that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3515duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003516names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3517is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3518implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3519encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3520adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003521
3522Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3523settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3524of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3525profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3526timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3529'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3530case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3531
3532Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3533logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3534proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3535However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3536name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3537
3538Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3539and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003540bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3542modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3543arbitrary criteria.
3544
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003545In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3546a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003547the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003548
3549 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3550 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3551 between responses and new requests.
3552
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003553 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3554 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3555 client-facing connection remains open.
3556
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003557 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3558 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003559
3560The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3561frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3562following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003563weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003564
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003565 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003566
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003567 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3568 ----+-----+-----+----
3569 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3570 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003571 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3572 ----+-----+-----+----
3573 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003574
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003575It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003576only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3577within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003578as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003579content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003580and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3581possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003583There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003584first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003585processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003586second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003587protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3588is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3589new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003590to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003591process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3592already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3593HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3594evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3595one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3596
3597There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3598performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3599tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3600preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3601analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3602HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3603header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3604mitigate this drawback.
3605
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003606There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003607method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3608set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3609in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3610is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3611to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3612above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3613to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3614"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3615frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3616frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3617as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3618upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3619on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3620the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3621upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3622frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3623remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036254.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3626--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003628The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3629limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3630they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3631limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003633option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003634and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3635with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003636specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3637sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3638anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003640
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3642------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003643acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644backlog X X X -
3645balance X - X X
3646bind - X X -
3647bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648capture cookie - X X -
3649capture request header - X X -
3650capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003651clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3652clitcpka-idle X X X -
3653clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003654compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003656declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657default-server X - X X
3658default_backend X X X -
3659description - X X X
3660disabled X X X X
3661dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003662email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003663email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003664email-alert mailers X X X X
3665email-alert myhostname X X X X
3666email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667enabled X X X X
3668errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003669errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003670errorloc X X X X
3671errorloc302 X X X X
3672-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3673errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003674error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003675force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003676filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003677fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003678hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003679http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003680http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003681http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003682http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003683http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003684http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003685http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003686http-check set-var X - X X
3687http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003688http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003689http-request X (!) X X X
3690http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003691http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003692http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003694ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003695load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003696log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003697log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003698log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003699log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003700max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701maxconn X X X -
3702mode X X X X
3703monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704monitor-uri X X X -
3705option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3706option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3707option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3708option allbackups (*) X - X X
3709option checkcache (*) X - X X
3710option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3711option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003712option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003713option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3714option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003715-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3716option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003717option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3718option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003719option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003720option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003721option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003722option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003723option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003724option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3725option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3726option httpchk X - X X
3727option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003728option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003729option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003730option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003731option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003732option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003733option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3734option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3735option logasap (*) X X X -
3736option mysql-check X - X X
3737option nolinger (*) X X X X
3738option originalto X X X X
3739option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003740option pgsql-check X - X X
3741option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003743option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744option smtpchk X - X X
3745option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3746option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3747option splice-request (*) X X X X
3748option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003749option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3751option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3752-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003753option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003754option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3755option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3756option tcpka X X X X
3757option tcplog X X X X
3758option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003759external-check command X - X X
3760external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003761persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3762rate-limit sessions X X X -
3763redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003764-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003765retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003766retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003767server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003768server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003769server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003770source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003771srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3772srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3773srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003774stats admin - X X X
3775stats auth X X X X
3776stats enable X X X X
3777stats hide-version X X X X
3778stats http-request - X X X
3779stats realm X X X X
3780stats refresh X X X X
3781stats scope X X X X
3782stats show-desc X X X X
3783stats show-legends X X X X
3784stats show-node X X X X
3785stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003786-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3787stick match - - X X
3788stick on - - X X
3789stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003790stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003791stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003792tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003793tcp-check connect X - X X
3794tcp-check expect X - X X
3795tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003796tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003797tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003798tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003799tcp-check set-var X - X X
3800tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003801tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
3802tcp-request content X (!) X X X
3803tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
3804tcp-request session X (!) X X -
3805tcp-response content X (!) - X X
3806tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003807timeout check X - X X
3808timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003809timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003810timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003811timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3812timeout http-request X X X X
3813timeout queue X - X X
3814timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003815timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003816timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003817timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003818transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003819unique-id-format X X X -
3820unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003821use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003822use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003823use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003824------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3825 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038284.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3829---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830
3831This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3832
3833
3834acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3835 Declare or complete an access list.
3836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003837 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
3838
3839 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
3840 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
3841 using it.
3842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843 Example:
3844 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3845 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3846 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003848 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003849
3850
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003851backlog <conns>
3852 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | yes | yes | no
3855 Arguments :
3856 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3857 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003858 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003859
3860 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3861 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3862 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3863 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3864 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3865 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3866 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3867 backlog parameter.
3868
3869 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3870 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3871 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3872
3873 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3874
3875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003877balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | no | yes | yes
3881 Arguments :
3882 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3883 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3884 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3885 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3886
3887 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3888 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3889 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3890 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003891 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003892 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003893 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3894 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3895 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3896 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3897 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3898 it, so that you don't worry.
3899
3900 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3901 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3902 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3903 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3904 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3905 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3906 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3907 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003908
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003909 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3910 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3911 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3912 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3913 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3914 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3915 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003916 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3917 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3918 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003919
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003920 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003921 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003922 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3923 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003924 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003925 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3926 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3927 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3928 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3929 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003930 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3931 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3932 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3933 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3934 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3935 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3938 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3939 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3940 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3941 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3942 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3943 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3944 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003945 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003947 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3948 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3949 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003951 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3952 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3953 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3954 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3955 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3956 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3957 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3958 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3959 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3960 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3961 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3962 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003963
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003964 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003965 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3966 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3967 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3968 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3969 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3970 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3971 URIs start with a leading "/".
3972
3973 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3974 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3975 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3976 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3977
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003978 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3979 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3980 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3981 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003983 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003984 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3985
3986 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003987 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3988 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003989 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3990 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3991 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3992 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003993 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003994 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3995 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003996
3997 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3998 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3999 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4000 server will receive the request.
4001
4002 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4003 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4004 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4005 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4006 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004007 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4008 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
4009 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004010
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004011 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4012 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4013 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4014 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4015 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004017 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004018 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4019 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4020 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4021
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4023 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4024 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4025
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004026 random
4027 random(<draws>)
4028 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004029 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4030 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4031 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4032 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004033 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4034 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4035 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4036 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4037 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4038 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4039 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4040 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4041 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4042 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4043 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4044 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4045 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4046 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4047 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4048 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4049 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4050 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4051 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4052 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004053
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004054 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004055 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004056 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4057 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
4058 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
4059 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4060 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4061 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004062 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004063 used instead.
4064
4065 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4066 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4067 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
4068 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
4069
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004070 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4071 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4072 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4073
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004074 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004077 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4078 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004079
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004080 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4081 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4082 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004083
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004084 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004085 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004086 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4087 NTLM relies on.
4088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004089 Examples :
4090 balance roundrobin
4091 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004092 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004093 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4094 balance hdr(host)
4095 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004096
4097 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4098 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004100 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004101 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4102 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4103 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004104 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004105
4106 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4107 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4108 defaults to 16 kB.
4109
4110 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4111 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4112
4113 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4114 Round Robin.
4115
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004116 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004117 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4118 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4119 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4120
4121 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4122
4123 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004124 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004125 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4126 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4127 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004129 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130
4131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004132bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4133bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004134 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 no | yes | yes | no
4137 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004138 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4139 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4140 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4141 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004142 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004143 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4144 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4145 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4146 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4147 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4148 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004149 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004150 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4151 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004152 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004153 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4154 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004155 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004156 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4157 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004158 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004159 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004160 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4161 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4162 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004163 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4164 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4165 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4166 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004167 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4168 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4169 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004170
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004171 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4172 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004173 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4174 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4175 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004176 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4177 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4178 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4179 the range.
4180
4181 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4182 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4183 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4184 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4185 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4186 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4187 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004188 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004189 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004190
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004191 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004192 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004193 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4194 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4195 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4196 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4197 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4198 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004200 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4201 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4202 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4203 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004205 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4206 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4207 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4208 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4209 in a frontend.
4210
4211 Example :
4212 listen http_proxy
4213 bind :80,:443
4214 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004215 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004217 listen http_https_proxy
4218 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004219 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004220
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004221 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4222 bind ipv6@:80
4223 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4224 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4225
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004226 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004227 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004228
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004229 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4230 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4231 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4232 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4233 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4234
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004235 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004236 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237
4238
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004239bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004242
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004243 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4244 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4245 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4246 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4247 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4248 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004249
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004250 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004251
4252
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004253capture cookie <name> len <length>
4254 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 no | yes | yes | no
4257 Arguments :
4258 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4259 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4260 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4261 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004262 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263
4264 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4265 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4266 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4267 right if it exceeds <length>.
4268
4269 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4270 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4271 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4272 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4273
4274 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4275 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4276 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4277
4278 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4279 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4280 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004281 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4282 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4283 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004284
4285 Example:
4286 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4287
4288 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004289 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004290
4291
4292capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004293 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4295 no | yes | yes | no
4296 Arguments :
4297 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004298 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004299 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4300 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4301 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4302
4303 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4304 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4305 it exceeds <length>.
4306
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004307 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004308 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4309 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004310 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4311 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4312 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4313 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004314 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004315 environments to find where the request came from.
4316
4317 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4318 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4319 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4320 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004321
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004322 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4323 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4324 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4325 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4326 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327
4328 Example:
4329 capture request header Host len 15
4330 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004331 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004333 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334 about logging.
4335
4336
4337capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004338 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 no | yes | yes | no
4341 Arguments :
4342 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004343 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004344 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4345 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4346 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4347
4348 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4349 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4350 it exceeds <length>.
4351
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004352 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004353 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4354 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4355 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004356 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4357 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4358 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4359 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004361 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4362 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4363 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4364 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4365 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004366
4367 Example:
4368 capture response header Content-length len 9
4369 capture response header Location len 15
4370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004371 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004372 about logging.
4373
4374
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004375clitcpka-cnt <count>
4376 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4377 the connection on the client side.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | yes | yes | no
4380 Arguments :
4381 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4382
4383 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4384 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004385 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4386 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004387
4388 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4389
4390
4391clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4392 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4393 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4394 client side.
4395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | yes | yes | no
4397 Arguments :
4398 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4399 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4400 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4401 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4402
4403 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4404 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004405 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4406 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004407
4408 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4409
4410
4411clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4412 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | yes | yes | no
4415 Arguments :
4416 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4417 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4418 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4419 document.
4420
4421 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4422 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004423 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4424 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004425
4426 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4427
4428
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004429compression algo <algorithm> ...
4430compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004431 Enable HTTP compression.
4432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4433 yes | yes | yes | yes
4434 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004435 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4436 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004437
4438 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004439 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4440 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4441 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004443 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004444 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004445
4446 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4447 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4448 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4449 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4450 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004451 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004452
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004453 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4454 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4455 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4456 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4457 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4458 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4459 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004460 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004461
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004462 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004463 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004464 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004465 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004466 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004467 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004468 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004469
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004470 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004471 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4472 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004473 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004474 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004475 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4476 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4477 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4478 "multipart"
4479 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4480 header
4481 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4482 and later
4483 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4484 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004485 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004486
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004487 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004488
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004489 Examples :
4490 compression algo gzip
4491 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004492
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004493 See also : "compression offload"
4494
4495compression offload
4496 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 no | yes | yes | yes
4499
4500 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4501 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4502 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4503 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4504 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4505 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4506 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4507 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4508 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4509 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4510 then be used for such scenarios.
4511
4512 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4513 option is ignored.
4514
4515 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004516
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004517cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004518 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4519 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004520 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | no | yes | yes
4524 Arguments :
4525 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4526 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4527 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4528 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4529 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4530 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004531 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004532 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4533 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4534
4535 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004536 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004537 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4538 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4539 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4540 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004541 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4542 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004543 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004544 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4545 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004546
4547 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004548 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004549
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004550 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004551 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004552 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004553 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004554 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4555 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4556 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4557 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4558 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4559 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4560 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561
4562 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4563 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4564 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4565 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4566 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4567 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4568 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4569 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4570 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004571 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004572 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4573 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4574 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004575
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004576 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4577 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4578 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004579 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4580 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4581 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4582 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004583 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4584 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4585 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004586
4587 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4588 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4589 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4590 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4591 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4592 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4593 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4594 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4595 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4596
4597 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4598 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4599 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4600 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4601 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4602 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4603 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4604 persistence cookie in the cache.
4605 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4606
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004607 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4608 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004609 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004610 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4611 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004612 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004613 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4614 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4615 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4616 they logout.
4617
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004618 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004619 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4620 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4621 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4622
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004623 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004624 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4625 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4626 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4627 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4628 this attribute.
4629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004630 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004631 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004632 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4633 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4634 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4635 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4636 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4637 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004638
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004639 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4640 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4641 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4642 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4643 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4644 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4645 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4646 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004647 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004648 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4649 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4650 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4651 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4652 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4653 the site.
4654
4655 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4656 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4657 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4658 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4659 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4660 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4661 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4662 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4663 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4664 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4665 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4666 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4667 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004668 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004669 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4670 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4671
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004672 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4673 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4674 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4675 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4676 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4677 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4678
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004679 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004680 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4681 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4682 repeated.
4683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004684 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4685 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4686 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4687 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004689 Examples :
4690 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4691 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4692 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004693 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004694
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004695 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004697
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004698declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4699 Declares a capture slot.
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 no | yes | yes | no
4702 Arguments:
4703 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4704
4705 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4706 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4707 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4708 for use in the response.
4709
4710 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004711 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004712 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4713
4714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004715default-server [param*]
4716 Change default options for a server in a backend
4717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4718 yes | no | yes | yes
4719 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004720 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4721 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4722 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4723 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004724
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004725 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004726 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4727
4728 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004729
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731default_backend <backend>
4732 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4734 yes | yes | yes | no
4735 Arguments :
4736 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4737
4738 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4739 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4740 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4741 will catch all undetermined requests.
4742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004743 Example :
4744
4745 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4746 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4747 default_backend dynamic
4748
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004749 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004751
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004752description <string>
4753 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4755 no | yes | yes | yes
4756 Arguments : string
4757
4758 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4759 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4760 it describes.
4761 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4762
4763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004764disabled
4765 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4767 yes | yes | yes | yes
4768 Arguments : none
4769
4770 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4771 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4772 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4773 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4774 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4775 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4776 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4777
4778 See also : "enabled"
4779
4780
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004781dispatch <address>:<port>
4782 Set a default server address
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004785 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004786
4787 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4788 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4789 during start-up.
4790
4791 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4792 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4793 possible with normal servers.
4794
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004795 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004796 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4797 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4798 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4799 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4800
4801 See also : "server"
4802
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004803
4804dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4805 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | no | yes | yes
4808 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4809
4810 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004811 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004812 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4813 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004814 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004815 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817enabled
4818 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4820 yes | yes | yes | yes
4821 Arguments : none
4822
4823 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4824 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4825
4826 See also : "disabled"
4827
4828
4829errorfile <code> <file>
4830 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4832 yes | yes | yes | yes
4833 Arguments :
4834 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004835 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004836 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004837
4838 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004839 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004840 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004841 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4842 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004843
4844 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4845 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4846 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4847
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004848 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4849
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004850 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4851 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4852 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4853 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4854 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4855 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4856 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4857 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4858 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004860 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4861 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4862 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004863 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004864 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4865
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004866 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004867
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004868 Example :
4869 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004870 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004871 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4872 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4873
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004875errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4876 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4877 section.
4878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4879 yes | yes | yes | yes
4880 Arguments :
4881 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4882
4883 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004884 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004885 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4886 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004887
4888 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4889 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4890 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4891 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4892 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004893 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004894 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4895
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004896 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4897 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004898
4899 Example :
4900 errorfiles generic
4901 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4902
4903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004904errorloc <code> <url>
4905errorloc302 <code> <url>
4906 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | yes | yes | yes
4909 Arguments :
4910 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004911 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004912 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004913
4914 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4915 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4916 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4917 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004918 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
4920 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4921 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4922 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4923
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004924 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4925
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4927 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4928 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4929 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004930 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4932 request.
4933
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004934 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004935
4936
4937errorloc303 <code> <url>
4938 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4940 yes | yes | yes | yes
4941 Arguments :
4942 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004943 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004944 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945
4946 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4947 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4948 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4949 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004950 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004951
4952 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4953 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4954 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4955
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004956 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4957
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004958 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4959 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4960 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4961 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004962 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004963
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004964 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965
4966
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004967email-alert from <emailaddr>
4968 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004969 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | yes
4972
4973 Arguments :
4974
4975 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4976
4977 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4978 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4979
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004980 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004981 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4982 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004983
4984
4985email-alert level <level>
4986 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4987 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4989 yes | yes | yes | yes
4990
4991 Arguments :
4992
4993 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4994 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4995 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4996
4997 By default level is alert
4998
4999 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5000 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5001 for the proxy.
5002
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005003 Alerts are sent when :
5004
5005 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5006 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5007 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5008 is notice or lower
5009 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5010 and a health check status update occurs
5011
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005012 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5013 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005014 section 3.6 about mailers.
5015
5016
5017email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5018 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 yes | yes | yes | yes
5021
5022 Arguments :
5023
5024 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5025
5026 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5027 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5030 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005031
5032
5033email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5034 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5035 mailers.
5036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038
5039 Arguments :
5040
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005041 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005042
5043 By default the systems hostname is used.
5044
5045 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5046 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5047 for the proxy.
5048
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005049 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5050 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005051
5052
5053email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005054 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005055 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5057 yes | yes | yes | yes
5058
5059 Arguments :
5060
5061 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5062
5063 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5064 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5065
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005066 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005067 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5068
5069
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005070error-log-format <string>
5071 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5072 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | yes | yes | no
5074
5075 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5076 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5077 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5078 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005079 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5080
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005081 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5082 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5083 string in depth.
5084
5085 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5086 directives.
5087
5088
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005089force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5090 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005092 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005093
5094 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5095 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5096 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5097 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5098 marked down for maintenance operations.
5099
5100 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5101 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5102 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5103 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5104 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5105 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5106 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5107 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5108 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5109
5110 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5111 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5112 is used.
5113
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005114 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005115 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005117
5118filter <name> [param*]
5119 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 no | yes | yes | yes
5122 Arguments :
5123 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5124 referenced in section 9.
5125
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005126 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005127 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005128 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5129 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005130
5131 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5132 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5133
5134 Example:
5135 listen
5136 bind *:80
5137
5138 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5139 filter compression
5140 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5141
5142 compression algo gzip
5143 compression offload
5144
5145 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5146
5147 See also : section 9.
5148
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005150fullconn <conns>
5151 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5153 yes | no | yes | yes
5154 Arguments :
5155 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5156 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5157
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005158 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005159 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005160 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005161 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5162 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5163 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5164 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5165 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005166 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005168 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005169 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005170 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5171 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5172 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005174 Example :
5175 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5176 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5177 # connections.
5178 backend dynamic
5179 fullconn 10000
5180 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5181 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5182
5183 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5184
5185
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005186hash-balance-factor <factor>
5187 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5189 yes | no | no | yes
5190 Arguments :
5191 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5192 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005193 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005194
5195 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5196 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5197 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5198 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5199 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5200 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5201 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5202
5203 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5204 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5205 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5206 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5207 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5208
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005209 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5210 consistent hashing mechanism.
5211
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005212 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5213
5214
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005215hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005216 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5218 yes | no | yes | yes
5219 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005220 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5221 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005222
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005223 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5224 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5225 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5226 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5227 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5228 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5229 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5230 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5231 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5232 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005233
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005234 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5235 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5236 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5237 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5238 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5239 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5240 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5241 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5242 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5243 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5244 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5245 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5246 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005247 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5248 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005249
5250 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5251
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005252 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005253 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5254 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5255 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005256 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5257 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5258 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005259
5260 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5261 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005262 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5263 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5264 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5265 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5266
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005267 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005268 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5269 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5270 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5271 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5272 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5273 parameter.
5274
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005275 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5276 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5277 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5278 used on strings.
5279
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005280 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5281
5282 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5283 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5284 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5285 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5286 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5287 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5288 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5289 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5290 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5291 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5292 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5293 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005294
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005295 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5296 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5297 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005298
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005299 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005300
5301
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005302http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5303 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5304 ones).
5305
5306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005307 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005308
5309 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5310 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5311 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5312 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5313 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5314 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5315
5316 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5317 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5318 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5319
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005320 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5321 supported:
5322 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5323 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005324 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005325 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5326 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5327 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5328 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5329 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005330 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5331 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005332 - strict-mode { on | off }
5333 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5334
5335 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005336
5337 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5338 instance.
5339
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005340 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5341 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5342 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5343 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5344 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5345 a defaults section defining such rules.
5346
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005347 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5348 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5349 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5350
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005351 Example:
5352 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5353 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5354 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5355
5356http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5357
5358 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005359 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5360 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005361
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005362http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5363
5364 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5365 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5366 complete description.
5367
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005368http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5369
5370 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005371 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005372
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005373http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005374
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005375 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5376 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005377
5378http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5379 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5380
5381 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5382
5383 Example:
5384 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5385
5386 # applied to:
5387 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5388
5389 # outputs:
5390 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5391
5392 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5393
5394http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5395 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5396
5397 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5398
5399 Example:
5400 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5401
5402 # applied to:
5403 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5404
5405 # outputs:
5406 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5407
5408http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5409
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005410 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5411 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5412 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5413 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005414
5415http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5417
5418 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005419 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005420 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005421
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005422http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5423http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005424
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005425 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5426 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5427 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005428
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005429http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005430
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005431 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5432 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005433
5434http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5435
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005436 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5437 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005438
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005439
5440http-check comment <string>
5441 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5442 it fails.
5443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 yes | no | yes | yes
5445
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005446 Arguments :
5447 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5448 rule fails.
5449
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005450 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5451 user-friendly error reporting.
5452
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005453 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005454 "http-check expect".
5455
5456
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005457http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5458 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005459 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005460 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 yes | no | yes | yes
5463
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005464 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005465 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5466
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005468 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469
5470 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5471 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5472 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5473 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5474
5475 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5476
5477 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5478
5479 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5480
5481 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5482
5483 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5484
5485 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5486 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5487 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5488 is used.
5489
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005490 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5491 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5492 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5493 haproxy -vv.
5494
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005495 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5496
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005497 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5498 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5499 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5500 different ports or with different servers.
5501
5502 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5503 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5504 the port with a "http-check connect".
5505
5506 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5507 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5508 do.
5509
5510 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5511 unset-var or comment rules.
5512
5513 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005514 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5515 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5516 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5517 option httpchk
5518
5519 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005520 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005521 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005522 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005523 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005524 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005525
5526 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5527
5528 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005529
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005531http-check disable-on-404
5532 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005534 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005535 Arguments : none
5536
5537 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5538 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5539 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5540 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5541 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5542 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5543 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5544 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005545 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5546 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005547 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5548 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5549 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005551 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552
5553
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005554http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005555 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5556 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5557 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005558 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005560 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005561
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005562 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005563 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5564
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005565 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5566 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5567 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5568 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5569 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5570 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5571 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5572 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5573 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5574 result is always conclusive.
5575
5576 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5577 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5578 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005579 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5580 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005581 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5582 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005583 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5584 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5585 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005586
5587 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5588 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005589 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5590 supported :
5591 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5592 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005593 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5594 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5595 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5596 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5597 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005598
5599 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5600 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005601 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5602 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5603 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5604 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005605 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5606
5607 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5608 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5609 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5610 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5611
5612 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5613 informational message reported in logs if an error
5614 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5615 log-format string.
5616
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005617 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005618 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5619 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5621 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5622 details on the supported keywords.
5623
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005624 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5625 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5626 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5627 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005628
5629 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5630 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5631 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5632 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5633 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5634
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005635 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5636 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5637 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5638 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5639 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5640 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5641 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005642
5643 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005644 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5646 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5647 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5648 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5649
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005650 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5651 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005652 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5653 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5654 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5655 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5656 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5657 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5658 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5659 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005660 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5661 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5662 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5663 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5664 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5665 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5666 insensitive on the header names.
5667
5668 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5669 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5670 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5671 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5672 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5673 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005674
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005676 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005677 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5678 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5679 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5680 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5681 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005682 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005683 trace).
5684
5685 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005686 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005687 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5688 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5689 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5690 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5691 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005692 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005693
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005694 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5695 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5696 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5697 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5698 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5699 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5700
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005702 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005703 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5704 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5705 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5706 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5707 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5708 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5709
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005710 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5711 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5712 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5713 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5714 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005715
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005716 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5717 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5718
5719 Examples :
5720 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005721 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005722
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005723 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5724 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5725
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005727 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005728
5729 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005730 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005731
5732 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005733 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005734
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005735 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005736 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005737
5738
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005739http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005740 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5741 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005742 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5743 health checks.
5744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | no | yes | yes
5746 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005747 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5748
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005749 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5750 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5751 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5752 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5753 to invent non-standard ones.
5754
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005755 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5756 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5757 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5758 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5759
5760 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5761 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5762 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5763 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005764
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005765 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005767 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005768 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5769 to add it.
5770
5771 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5772 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5773 to the log-format rules.
5774
5775 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5776 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5777 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005778
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005779 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5780 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5781 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5782 request.
5783
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005784 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5785 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5786 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005787 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5788 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5789 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5790 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005791 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005792
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005793 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005794 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5795 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005796
5797 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5798 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5799 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5800 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5801 configured request authority.
5802
5803 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5804 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005805
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005806 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005807
5808
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005809http-check send-state
5810 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813 Arguments : none
5814
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005815 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005816 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005817 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5818 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5819 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005820
5821 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5822 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5823 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5824 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5825 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005826 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5827 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5828 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5829
5830 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5831 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5832 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5833
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005834 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5835 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5836 checked in multiple backends.
5837
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005838 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005839 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5840
5841 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5842 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5843 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5844 one fails.
5845
5846 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5847 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5848 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5849
5850 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5851 server's queue.
5852
5853 Example of a header received by the application server :
5854 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5855 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5856
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005857 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5858 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005859
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005861http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5862http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005863 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5865 yes | no | yes | yes
5866
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005867 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005868 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5869 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5870 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5871 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5872 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5874 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5875 and '-'.
5876
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005877 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
5878 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
5879 set-var converter's decription for a full list of possible
5880 conditions.
5881
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5883
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005884 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5885 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5886
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005887 Examples :
5888 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005889 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005890
5891
5892http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005893 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | no | yes | yes
5896
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005897 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005898 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5899 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5902 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5903 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5904 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5905 and '-'.
5906
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005907 Examples :
5908 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005910
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005911http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5912 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5913 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5914 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5915 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | yes | yes | yes
5918 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005919 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005920 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005921 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005922 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005923
5924 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5925 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5926 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5927 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5928
5929 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5930 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5931 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5932 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5933
5934 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5935 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5936 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5937 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5938 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5939 chroot is performed.
5940
5941 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5942 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5943 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5944 considered.
5945
5946 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5947 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5948 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5949 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5950 considered as a raw string.
5951
5952 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5953 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5954 "content-type".
5955
5956 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5957 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5958 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5959 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5960 evaluated as a log-format string.
5961
5962 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5963 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5964 argument to "content-type".
5965
5966 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5967 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5968 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5969 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5970
5971 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5972 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5973 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5974 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5975 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5976 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5977 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5978 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5979
5980 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5981 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5982 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5983
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005984 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5985 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5986 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5987 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5988 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5989
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005990 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5991 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5992
5993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005995 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5996
5997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005998 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005999
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006000 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6001 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6002 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6003 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6004 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006005
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006006 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6007 supported:
6008 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6009 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6010 - allow
6011 - auth [realm <realm>]
6012 - cache-use <name>
6013 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6014 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6015 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6016 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6017 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6018 - disable-l7-retry
6019 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6020 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6021 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6022 - redirect <rule>
6023 - reject
6024 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6025 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6026 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6027 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6028 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6029 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6030 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6031 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6032 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6033 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6034 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6035 - set-dst <expr>
6036 - set-dst-port <expr>
6037 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6038 - set-log-level <level>
6039 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6040 - set-mark <mark>
6041 - set-method <fmt>
6042 - set-nice <nice>
6043 - set-path <fmt>
6044 - set-pathq <fmt>
6045 - set-priority-class <expr>
6046 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6047 - set-query <fmt>
6048 - set-src <expr>
6049 - set-src-port <expr>
6050 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6051 - set-tos <tos>
6052 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006053 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6054 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006055 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6056 - silent-drop
6057 - strict-mode { on | off }
6058 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6059 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6060 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6061 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6062 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6063 - use-service <service-name>
6064 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6065 - wait-for-handshake
6066 - cache-use <name>
6067
6068 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006071
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006072 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6073 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6074 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6075 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6076 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6077 a defaults section defining such rules.
6078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079 Example:
6080 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6081 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6082 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084 http-request allow if nagios
6085 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6086 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6087 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089 Example:
6090 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6091 acl add path /addacl
6092 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006094 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006096 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6097 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006099 Example:
6100 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6101 acl setmap path /setmap
6102 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006106 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6107 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6110 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6115 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6116 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6117 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6118 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6119 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6120 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6121 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006125 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6126 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6127 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6128 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6129 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6130 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6131 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6132 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006134http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006137 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006139http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006141 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6142 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6143 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6144 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6145 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006146
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006147 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6148 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6149 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6150 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6151 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6152 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6153 instead.
6154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006155 Example:
6156 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6157 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006158
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006159http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006160
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006161 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6164 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006166 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6167 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6168 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6169 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6170 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6171 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6172 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6173 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6174 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006176 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6177 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6178 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006179 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6180
6181 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6182 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6183 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6184 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006186http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006188 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6189 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6190 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6191 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6192 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6193 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006194
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006195http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006196
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006197 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6198 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6199 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6200 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6201 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006203http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006205 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6206 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6207 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6208 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6209 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6210 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006211
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006212http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6213http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6214 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6215 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6216 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6217 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006218
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6220 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6221 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006222 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006223 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6224 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6225 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006226 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006227 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006228
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006229http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6230 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6231 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6232 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6233
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006234http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006236
6237 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6238 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6239 pointed by <resolvers>.
6240 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6241 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6242 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6243 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6244 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6245 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6246 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6247 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6248 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6249 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6250 to 0.0.0.0.
6251
6252 Example:
6253 resolvers mydns
6254 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6255 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6256 timeout retry 1s
6257 hold valid 10s
6258 hold nx 3s
6259 hold other 3s
6260 hold obsolete 0s
6261 accepted_payload_size 8192
6262
6263 frontend fe
6264 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6265 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6266 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6267
6268 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6269 # which mean DNS resolution error
6270 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6271
6272 default_backend be
6273
6274 backend b_503
6275 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6276 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6277 # 503 error page to end users
6278
6279 backend be
6280 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6281 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6282 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6283 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6284 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6285
6286 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6287 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6288
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006289http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6290
6291 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6292 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6293 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6294 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006295 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6296 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006297
6298 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6299
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006300http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006301http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006302http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006303http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006304http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006305http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006306http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006307http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6308http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006309
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006310 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6311
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006312 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006313 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6314 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6315 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6316 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006317
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006318 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6319 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6320 the supported backend.
6321
6322 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6323 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6324 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6325 number of segments in the path.
6326
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006327 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6328 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6329 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6330 when improperly combined.
6331
6332 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6333 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6334 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6335 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6336 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6337
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006338 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006339
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006340 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6341
6342 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6343 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6344
6345 Example:
6346 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6347
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006348 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6349
6350 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6351 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6352
6353 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6354 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6355
6356 Example:
6357 - /#foo -> /
6358
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006359 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6360 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006361
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006362 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6363 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6364
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006365 Example:
6366 - /. -> /
6367 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6368 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6369 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006370
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006371 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6372 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6373
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006374 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006375 their preceding segment.
6376
6377 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6378 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6379
6380 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6381 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006382
6383 Example:
6384 - /foo/../ -> /
6385 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6386 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6387 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006388 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006389 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006390 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006391
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006392 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6393 removed as well:
6394
6395 Example:
6396 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6397 - /bar/../../ -> /
6398
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006399 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6400 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006401
6402 Example:
6403 - // -> /
6404 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6405
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006406 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6407 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6408
6409 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6410 ".", "_", and "~".
6411
6412 Example:
6413 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6414 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6415 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6416 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6417
6418 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6419 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6420
6421 Example:
6422 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6423 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6424
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006425 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006426 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006427
6428 Example:
6429 - /%6f -> /%6F
6430 - /%zz -> /%zz
6431
6432 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6433 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6434
6435 Example:
6436 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6437
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006438 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006439 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6440 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6441
6442 Example:
6443 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6444 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6445 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006447http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006449 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6450 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6451 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6452 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6453 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006455http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006457 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6458 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6459 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6460 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006464
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006465 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006466 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6467 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6468 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6469 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6470 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006471
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006472 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6473 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6474 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6475 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6476 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006477
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006478 Example:
6479 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6480
6481 # applied to:
6482 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6483
6484 # outputs:
6485 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6486
6487 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006488
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006489 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6490
6491 # applied to:
6492 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006493
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006494 # outputs:
6495 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006496
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006497http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6499
6500 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6501 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006502 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6503 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6504 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006505
6506 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6507 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6508 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6509
6510 Example:
6511 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6512 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6513
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006514 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6515 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6516 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6517 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6518
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006519http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6520 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6521
6522 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6523 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6524 query-string are replaced.
6525
6526 Example:
6527 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6528 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6529
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006530http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6531 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6532
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006533 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6534 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6535 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6536 against.
6537
6538 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6539 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6540 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006541
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006542 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6543 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6544 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6545 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6546 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6547 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6548 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6549 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6550 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006551 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6552 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006553
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006554 Example:
6555 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6556 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006557
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006558 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6559 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006561http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6562 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006563
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006564 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6565 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6566 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6567 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006568
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006569 Example:
6570 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006571
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006572 # applied to:
6573 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006574
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006575 # outputs:
6576 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006577
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006578http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6579 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6580 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006581 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006582 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6583
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006584 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006585 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6586 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006587 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006588 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006589 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006590 are followed to create the response :
6591
6592 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6593 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6594 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6595 ignored.
6596
6597 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6598 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006599 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006600 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6601 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006602
6603 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6604 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6605 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006606 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006607 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006608
6609 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6610 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6611 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006612 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006613 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006614 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006615
6616 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6617 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6618 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6619 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6620 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6621 as a raw content.
6622
6623 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6624 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6625 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6626 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6627 considered as a raw string.
6628
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006629 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006630 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6631 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6632 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6633
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006634 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6635 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006636 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006637
6638 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6639
6640 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006641 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006642 if { path /ping }
6643
6644 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6645 if { path /favicon.ico }
6646
6647 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6648 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6649 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6650
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006651http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6652
6653 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6654 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6655 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6656 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6657 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6658 at this index.
6659 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6660 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6663http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6666 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6667 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006668
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006669http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6671 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6672 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6673 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6674 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6675 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6676 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6677 at this index.
6678 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6679 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6680
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006681http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6682 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006683
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006684 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6685 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6686 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6687 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006688
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006689http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6690 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6691
6692 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6693 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6694 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6695 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6696 agent name must be used.
6697
6698 Arguments:
6699 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6700
6701 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6702 configuration.
6703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006704http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6707 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6708 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6709 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6710 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 Arguments:
6713 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6714 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006716 Example:
6717 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6718 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6721 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006723http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6726 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6727 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 Arguments:
6730 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6731 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006733 Example:
6734 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6735 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6738 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6739 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006743 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6744 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6745 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6746 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6747 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749 Example:
6750 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6751 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6752 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6753 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6754 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6755 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6756 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6757 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6758 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006760http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6763 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6764 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6765 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6766 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006768http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6769 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6772 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6773 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6774 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6775 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6776 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6777 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6778 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6779 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006782
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006783 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6784 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6785 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6786 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6787 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6788 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6789 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006790 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6791 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006793http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006795 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6796 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6797 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006799http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006801 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6802 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6803 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6804 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6805 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6806 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6807 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6808 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006810http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006812 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6813 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6814 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6815 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6816 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6817 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006819 Example :
6820 # prepend the host name before the path
6821 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006822
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006823http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824
6825 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6826 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6827 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006829http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006831 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6832 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6833 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6834 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6835 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006837http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006839 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6840 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6841 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6842 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6843 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6844 values have higher priority.
6845 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6846 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6847 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6848 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6849 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006851http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006853 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6854 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6855 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6856 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6857 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6858 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6859 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006861 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006862
6863 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006864 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6865 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006867http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6868 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6869 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6870 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006871 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6872 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006873
6874 Arguments :
6875 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6876 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006877
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006878 See also "option forwardfor".
6879
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006880 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006881 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6882 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6883
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006884 # After the masking this will track connections
6885 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6886 http-request track-sc0 src
6887
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006888 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6889 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6890
6891http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6892
6893 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6894 expression.
6895
6896 Arguments:
6897 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6898 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006899
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006900 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006901 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6902 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6903
6904 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6905 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6906 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6907
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006908http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006909 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6910
6911 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6912 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6913 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6914 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6915 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6916
6917 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6918 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6919 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6920 results.
6921
6922 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006923 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6924 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006925
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006926http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6927
6928 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6929 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6930 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6931 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6932 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6933 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6934 information from the request.
6935
6936 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6937
6938http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6939
6940 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6941 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6942 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6943 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6944 path and the query string.
6945 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6946
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006947http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6948http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006949
6950 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6951 inline.
6952
6953 Arguments:
6954 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6955 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6958 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6959 (request and response)
6960 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6961 processing
6962 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6963 processing
6964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6965 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6966 and '_'.
6967
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006968 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6969 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
6970 set-var converter's decription for a full list of possible
6971 conditions.
6972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006973 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6974 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006975
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006976 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6977 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6978
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006979 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006980 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006981 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
6982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006983http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6984
6985 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6986 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6987 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6988 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6989 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6990 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6991 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6992 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6993 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6994 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6995 action.
6996 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6997 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6998 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6999 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7000 you fully understand how it works.
7001
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007002http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007003
7004 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7005 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7006 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7007 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7008 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007009 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007010 processing.
7011
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007012 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007013 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7014 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7015 rules evaluation.
7016
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007017http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7018http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7019 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7020 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7021 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007023
7024 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7025 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7026 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007027 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7028 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7029 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7030 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7031 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7032 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007033 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007034 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7035 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7036 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007037 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007038 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7039 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7040 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7041 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7042 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007043
7044http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7045http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7046http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7047
7048 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7049 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7050 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7051 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007052 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007053 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7054 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7055 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7056 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7057 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7058 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7059 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7060
7061 Arguments :
7062 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7063 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7064 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7065 select which table entry to update the counters.
7066
7067 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7068 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7069 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7070 that table until the session ends.
7071
7072 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7073 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7074 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7075 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7076 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7077 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7078 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7079 useful information.
7080
7081 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7082 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7083 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7084 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7085 checks that make use of it.
7086
7087http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7088
7089 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007090
7091 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007092 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007093
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007094http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7095
7096 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7097 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7098 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7099 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7100 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7101 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7102
7103 Arguments :
7104 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7105
7106 Example:
7107 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7108
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007109http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7111
7112 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7113 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7114 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7115 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7116 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7117 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7118 http-buffer-request".
7119
7120 Arguments :
7121
7122 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7123 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7124
7125 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007126 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007127 bytes.
7128
7129 Example:
7130 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7131
7132 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007134http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007136 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7137 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7138 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007139
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007141http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007142 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7143
7144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007145 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007146
7147 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7148 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7149 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7150 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7151 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7152 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7153
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007154 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7155 supported:
7156 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7157 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7158 - allow
7159 - cache-store <name>
7160 - capture <sample> id <id>
7161 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7162 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7163 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7164 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7165 - redirect <rule>
7166 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7167 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7168 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7169 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7170 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7171 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7172 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7173 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7174 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7175 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7176 - set-log-level <level>
7177 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7178 - set-mark <mark>
7179 - set-nice <nice>
7180 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7181 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007182 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7183 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007184 - silent-drop
7185 - strict-mode { on | off }
7186 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7187 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7188 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7189 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7190 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7191
7192 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007194 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007195
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007196 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7197 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7198 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7199 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7200 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7201 a defaults section defining such rules.
7202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007203 Example:
7204 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007206 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007208 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7209 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007211 Example:
7212 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007214 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7217 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007219 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7220 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007223
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007224 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7225 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007227http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007228
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007229 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007230 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7231 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007233http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007234
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007235 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7236 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007237
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007238http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007239
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007240 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007242http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007244 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7245 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7246 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7247 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7248 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7249 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7250 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007252 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7253 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7254 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7255 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7256 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007257
7258 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7259 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7260 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7261 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007263http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007264
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007265 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7266 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007267
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007268http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007269
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007270 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7271 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007273http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007274
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007275 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7276 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007277
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007278http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7279http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7280 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7281 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7282 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7283 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007284
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007285 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7286 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7287 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007288 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007289 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7290 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7291 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007292 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007293 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007295http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007296
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007297 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7298 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7299 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7300 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7301 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7302 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007303
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007304http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007306
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007307 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7308 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007309
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007310 Example:
7311 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007313 # applied to:
7314 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007316 # outputs:
7317 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007319 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7322 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007323
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007324 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007325 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007327 Example:
7328 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007330 # applied to:
7331 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007333 # outputs:
7334 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007335
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007336http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7337 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7338 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007339 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007340 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7341
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007342 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7343 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7344 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007345
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007346http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007347http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7348http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007349
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007350 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7351 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7352 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7353 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007354
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007355http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007356 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007357http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7358 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007359http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7360 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007361
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007362 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7363 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7364 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007365
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007366http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7367 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007368
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007369 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7370 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007371
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007372http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007373
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007374 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7375 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7376 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7377 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007378
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007379http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7380
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007381 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7382 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007383
7384http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7385
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007386 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7387 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388
7389http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7390
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007391 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7392 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7393 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007394
7395http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007397 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7398 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007399
7400http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7401 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7402
7403 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7404 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7405 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7406 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007407
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007408 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007409 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7410 http-response set-status 431
7411 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7412 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007413
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007414http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007415
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007416 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007417 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7418 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007419
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007420http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7421http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007422
7423 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007424 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7425 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007427http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007429 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7430 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007431 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7432 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007433
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007434http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007435
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007436 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7437 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007439http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7440http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7441http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007442
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007443 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7444 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7445 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007446
7447http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7448
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007449 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007450 about <var-name>.
7451
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007452http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7453 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7454
7455 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007456 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7457 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007458
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007459
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007460http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7461 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7462
7463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7464 yes | no | yes | yes
7465
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007466 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007467 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7468 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7469 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007470
7471 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7472
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007473 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7474 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7475 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7476 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7477 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7478 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7479 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007480 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007481 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7482 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007483
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007484 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7485 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7486 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7487 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7488 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7489 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7490 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007491 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7492 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7493 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7494 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7495 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7496 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007497
7498 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7499 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7500 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7501 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7502 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7503 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7504 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7505 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007506 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007507 downsides of rare connection failures.
7508
7509 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7510 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7511 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7512 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7513 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7514 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007515 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007516 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7517 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7518 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7519 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7520 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7521
7522 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007523 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7524 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7525 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7526 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007527
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007528 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7529 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007530
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007531 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007532
7533 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7534 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7535 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7536
7537 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7538
7539
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007540http-send-name-header [<header>]
7541 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7543 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007544 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007545 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7546
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007547 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7548 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7549 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7550 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7551 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7552 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7553 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7554 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7555 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7556 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7557 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7558 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7559 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7560 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7561 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7562 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007563
7564 See also : "server"
7565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007566id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007567 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7569 no | yes | yes | yes
7570 Arguments : none
7571
7572 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7573 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7574 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007575
7576
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007577ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7578 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007580 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007581
7582 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7583 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7584 and running).
7585
7586 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7587 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7588 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007589 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007590 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007592 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7593 "unless" condition is met.
7594
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007595 Example:
7596 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7597 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7598 ignore-persist if url_static
7599
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007600 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7601
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007602load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7603 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7605 yes | no | yes | yes
7606
7607 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7608 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7609 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007610 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007611 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007612 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7613 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7614 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007616 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007617 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007618 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007619
7620 Arguments:
7621 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7622 named "server-state-file".
7623
7624 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7625 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7626 name is used as a file name.
7627
7628 none don't load any stat for this backend
7629
7630 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007631 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7632 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7633 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007634 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007635 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007636
7637 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7638 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7639
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007640 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007641
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007642 global
7643 stats socket /tmp/socket
7644 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007645
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007646 defaults
7647 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007648
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007649 backend bk
7650 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7651 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007652
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007653
7654 Then one can run :
7655
7656 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7657
7658 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7659
7660 1
7661 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7662 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7663 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7664
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007665 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007666
7667 global
7668 stats socket /tmp/socket
7669 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7670
7671 defaults
7672 load-server-state-from-file local
7673
7674 backend bk
7675 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7676 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7677
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007678
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007679 Then one can run :
7680
7681 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7682
7683 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7684
7685 1
7686 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7687 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7688 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7689
7690 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7691 "show servers state"
7692
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007694log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007695log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007696 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007697no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007698 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7700 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007701
7702 Prefix :
7703 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7704 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7705 prefix does not allow arguments.
7706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007707 Arguments :
7708 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7709 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7710 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7711 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7712 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7713 parameter.
7714
7715 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7716 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7717
7718 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7719 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7720 standard syslog port).
7721
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007722 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7723 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7724 standard syslog port).
7725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007726 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7727 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7728 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007729 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007730
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007731 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7732 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7733 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7734 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7735 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7736 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7737 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7738 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7739 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7740 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7741 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7742 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007743 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007744 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7745 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7746 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007747 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7748 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007749
7750 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7751 and "fd@2", see above.
7752
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007753 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7754 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7755 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7756 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7757 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7758 having the logs instantly available.
7759
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007760 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7761 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7762 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7763
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007764 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7765 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007766
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007767 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7768 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7769 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7770 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7771 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7772 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7773 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7774 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7775 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7776 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007777 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007778
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007779 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7780 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7781 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7782 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7783 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7784
7785 <sample_size>
7786 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7787 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7788 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7789 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7790 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7791
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007792 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7793 one of the following :
7794
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007795 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7796 field is stripped. This is the default.
7797 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7798 rfc3164.
7799
7800 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007801 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7802
7803 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7804 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7805
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007806 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7807 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7808 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7809 designed to be used with a local log server.
7810
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007811 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7812 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7813 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7814 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7815 systemd logger consumes.
7816
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007817 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7818 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7819 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7820 used with a local log server.
7821
7822 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7823 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7824 designed to be used with a local log server.
7825
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007826 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7827 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7828 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7829 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7830
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007831 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7832
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007833 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7834 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7835 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7836
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007837 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7838 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7839 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7840 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007841
7842 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7843 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7844 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007845 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7846 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7847 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7848 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7849 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007850
7851 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7852
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007853 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7854 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7855 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007856
7857 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7858 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7859 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7860 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7861
7862 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7863 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007864
7865 Example :
7866 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007867 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7868 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7869 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007870 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007871 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7872 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007873 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007875
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007876log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007877 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7879 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007880
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007881 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7882 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7883 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7884 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7885 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007886 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7887 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007888
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007889 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7890 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007891
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007892log-format-sd <string>
7893 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7895 yes | yes | yes | no
7896
7897 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7898 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7899 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7900 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7901 which covers the log format string in depth.
7902
7903 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7904 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7905
7906 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7907 log format to "rfc5424".
7908
7909 Example :
7910 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7911
7912
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007913log-tag <string>
7914 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7916 yes | yes | yes | yes
7917
7918 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7919 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007920 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007921 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7922 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7923 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7924 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7925 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7926 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007927
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007928max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7929 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7931 yes | no | yes | yes
7932
7933 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7934 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7935 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7936 servers.
7937
7938 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007939 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007940 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7941 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7942 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007943 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007944 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7945 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7946 picking a different server.
7947
7948 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7949 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7950 even if they have to be queued.
7951
7952 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7953 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7954
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007955max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7956 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7957 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7958 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007960maxconn <conns>
7961 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | yes | yes | no
7964 Arguments :
7965 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7966 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7967 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7968 closes.
7969
7970 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007971 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007972 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7973 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007974 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7975 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7976 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7977 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007978
7979 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7980 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7981 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7982
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007983 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7984 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007985
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007986 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7987
7988
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007989mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007990 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7992 yes | yes | yes | yes
7993 Arguments :
7994 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7995 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7996 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7997 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7998
7999 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8000 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8001 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8002 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8003 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8004
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008005 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8006 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8007 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008009 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008010 defaults http_instances
8011 mode http
8012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008013
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008014monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008015 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8017 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008018 Arguments :
8019 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8020 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008021 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008022 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8023 backend and its backup.
8024
8025 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8026 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8027 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8028 servers in a list of backends.
8029
8030 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8031 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8032 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008033 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008034 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8035 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008036 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008037 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8038 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008039
8040 Example:
8041 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008042 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008043 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8044 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8045 monitor-uri /site_alive
8046 monitor fail if site_dead
8047
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008048 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008049
8050
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008051monitor-uri <uri>
8052 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8054 yes | yes | yes | no
8055 Arguments :
8056 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8057 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8058
8059 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8060 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8061 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8062 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8063 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8064 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8065 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8066 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8067
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008068 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008069 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8070 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8071 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8072 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8073 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8074 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008075
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008076 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8077 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8078 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8079 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008081 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008082 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008083 frontend www
8084 mode http
8085 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8086
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008087 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008089
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008090option abortonclose
8091no option abortonclose
8092 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8094 yes | no | yes | yes
8095 Arguments : none
8096
8097 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8098 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8099 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8100 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008101 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008102 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8103 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8104 encountered while delivering the response.
8105
8106 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8107 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8108 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8109 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8110 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8111 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008112 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008113 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008114 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008115 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8116 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8117 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008119 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8120 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008121 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8122 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8123 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8124 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8125 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8126 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008127 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008128
8129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8131
8132 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8133
8134
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008135option accept-invalid-http-request
8136no option accept-invalid-http-request
8137 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | yes | yes | no
8140 Arguments : none
8141
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008142 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008143 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008144 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008145 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8146 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8147 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8148 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8149 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008150 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8151 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8152 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8153 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008154 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008155 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008156 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8157 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8158 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008159
8160 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8161 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8162 been confirmed.
8163
8164 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8165 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008166 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8167 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008168 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8169
8170 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8171 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8172
8173 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8174 stats socket.
8175
8176
8177option accept-invalid-http-response
8178no option accept-invalid-http-response
8179 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8181 yes | no | yes | yes
8182 Arguments : none
8183
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008184 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008185 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008186 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008187 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8188 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8189 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8190 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8191 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008192 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8193 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8194 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008195
8196 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8197 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8198 been confirmed.
8199
8200 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8201 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8202 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8203 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8204
8205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8207
8208 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8209 stats socket.
8210
8211
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008212option allbackups
8213no option allbackups
8214 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8216 yes | no | yes | yes
8217 Arguments : none
8218
8219 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8220 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8221 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8222 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8223 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8224 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8225 order between the backup servers anymore.
8226
8227 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8228 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8229
8230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8232
8233
8234option checkcache
8235no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008236 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8238 yes | no | yes | yes
8239 Arguments : none
8240
8241 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8242 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008243 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008244 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8245 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008246 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008247
8248 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008249 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008250 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008251 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8252 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008253 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008255 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8256 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008257 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008258 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8259 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008260 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008261 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8262 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8263 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8264 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8265 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8266 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8268 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8269 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8270
8271 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008272 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8273 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8274 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8275 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008276
8277 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8278 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008279 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008280 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008281
8282 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8283 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8284
8285
8286option clitcpka
8287no option clitcpka
8288 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8290 yes | yes | yes | no
8291 Arguments : none
8292
8293 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8294 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008295 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008296 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8297
8298 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8299 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8300 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8301 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8302
8303 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8304 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8305 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8306 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8307 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8308
8309 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8310
8311 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8312 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8313 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8314
8315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8317
8318 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8319
8320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008321option contstats
8322 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8324 yes | yes | yes | no
8325 Arguments : none
8326
8327 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8328 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8329 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008330 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008331 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8332 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8333 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8334 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8335 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008336
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008337option disable-h2-upgrade
8338no option disable-h2-upgrade
8339 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8340 connection.
8341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | yes | yes | no
8343 Arguments : none
8344
8345 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8346 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8347 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8348 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008349 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8350 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8351 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8352 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8353 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8354 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008355
8356 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8357 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008358
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008359option dontlog-normal
8360no option dontlog-normal
8361 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8363 yes | yes | yes | no
8364 Arguments : none
8365
8366 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8367 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8368 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8369 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8370 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8371 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8372 logged.
8373
8374 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8375 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8376 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008378 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008379 logging.
8380
8381
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008382option dontlognull
8383no option dontlognull
8384 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8386 yes | yes | yes | no
8387 Arguments : none
8388
8389 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8390 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8391 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8392 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8393 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8394 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008395 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8396 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8397 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008398
8399 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008400 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008401 would not be logged.
8402
8403 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8404 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8405
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008406 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008407 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008408
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008409
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008410option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008411 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 yes | yes | yes | yes
8414 Arguments :
8415 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8416 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008417 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008418 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008419
8420 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8421 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8422 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8423 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8424 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8425 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8426 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008427 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8428 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8429 possible that the client has already brought one.
8430
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008431 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008432 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008433 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008434 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008435 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008436 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008437
8438 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8439 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8440 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8441 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8442 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8443 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008444 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008445
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008446 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8447 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008448 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008449 are under the control of the end-user.
8450
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008451 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008452 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8453 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008454 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8455 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8456 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008457
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008458 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008459 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8460 frontend www
8461 mode http
8462 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8463
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008464 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8465 backend www
8466 mode http
8467 option forwardfor header X-Client
8468
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008469 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008470 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008471
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008472
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008473option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8474no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8475 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8477 yes | yes | yes | no
8478 Arguments : none
8479
8480 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8481 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8482 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8483 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8484 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8485 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8486 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8487
8488 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8489 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8490 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8491 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8492 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8493 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8494 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8495 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8496 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8497 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8498
8499 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8500
8501 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8502 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8503
8504 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8505 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8506
8507
8508option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8509no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8510 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8512 yes | no | yes | yes
8513 Arguments : none
8514
8515 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8516 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8517 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8518 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8519 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8520 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8521 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8522
8523 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8524 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8525 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8526 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8527 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8528 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8529 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8530 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8531 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8532 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8533
8534 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8535
8536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8538
8539 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8540 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8541
8542
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008543option http-buffer-request
8544no option http-buffer-request
8545 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8547 yes | yes | yes | yes
8548 Arguments : none
8549
8550 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8551 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8552 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8553 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8554 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8555 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008556 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8557 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8558 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8559 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008560
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008561 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8562 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008563
8564
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008565option http-ignore-probes
8566no option http-ignore-probes
8567 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8569 yes | yes | yes | no
8570 Arguments : none
8571
8572 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8573 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8574 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8575 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8576 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8577 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8578 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8579 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8580 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008581 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8582 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008583 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8584
8585 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8586 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8587 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8588 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8589 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8590 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8591 are often the only way to detect them.
8592
8593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8595
8596 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8597
8598
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008599option http-keep-alive
8600no option http-keep-alive
8601 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8603 yes | yes | yes | yes
8604 Arguments : none
8605
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008606 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8607 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008608 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8609 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008610 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8611 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8612 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008613
8614 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8615 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008616 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8617 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8618 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8619 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8620 situations where this option may be useful :
8621
8622 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008623 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008624
8625 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8626 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8627
8628 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8629 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8630 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8631 request.
8632
8633 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8634 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008635 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8636 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8637 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008638
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008639 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8640 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8641 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8642 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8643 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8644 not set.
8645
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008646 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8647 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8648 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008649
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008650 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008651 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008652 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008653
8654
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008655option http-no-delay
8656no option http-no-delay
8657 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8659 yes | yes | yes | yes
8660 Arguments : none
8661
8662 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8663 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8664 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8665 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8666 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8667 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8668 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008669 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008670 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8671 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8672 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8673 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8674 affected.
8675
8676 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8677 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8678 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8679 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8680 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8681 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8682 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8683 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8684 latency environments.
8685
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008686 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8687
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008688
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008689option http-pretend-keepalive
8690no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008691 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008693 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008694 Arguments : none
8695
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008696 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008697 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8698 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8699 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008700 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008701 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8702 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8703 consider the response complete.
8704
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008705 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008706 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008707 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008708 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008709 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008710 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8711
8712 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8713 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8714 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8715 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008716 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8717 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008718 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8719
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008720 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8721 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8722 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8723 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8724 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8725 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008726
8727 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8728 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8729
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008730 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008731 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008732
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008733
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008734option http-server-close
8735no option http-server-close
8736 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8738 yes | yes | yes | yes
8739 Arguments : none
8740
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008741 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8742 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8743 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8744 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008745 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8746 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8747 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8748 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8749 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8750 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8751 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8752 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8753 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8754 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8755 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008756
8757 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8758 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8759 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8760 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008761 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8762 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008763
8764 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8765 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008766 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8767 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8768 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008769
8770 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8771 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8772
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008773 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8774 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008775
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008776option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008777no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008778 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8780 yes | yes | yes | no
8781 Arguments : none
8782
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008783 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008784 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8785 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8786 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8787 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8788 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008789 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008790
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008791 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008792 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008793 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8794 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8795 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008796
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008797 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8798 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8799 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8800 front of an existing proxy.
8801
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008802 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8803
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008804 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008805
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008806option httpchk
8807option httpchk <uri>
8808option httpchk <method> <uri>
8809option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008810 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 yes | no | yes | yes
8813 Arguments :
8814 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8815 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8816 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8817 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8818 ones.
8819
8820 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8821 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8822 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8823
8824 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8825 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8826 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008827 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008828
8829 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8830 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8831 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8832 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8833 the lack of any response.
8834
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008835 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8836 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8837 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8838 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8839
8840 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8841 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8842 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008843
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008844 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8845 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008846 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008847 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008848 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008849
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008850 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8851 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8852 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8853 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8854
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008855 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008856 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8857 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8858 backend https_relay
8859 mode tcp
8860 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8861 http-check send hdr Host www
8862 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008863
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008864 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8865 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8866 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008867
8868
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008869option httpclose
8870no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008871 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8873 yes | yes | yes | yes
8874 Arguments : none
8875
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008876 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8877 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8878 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8879 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008880 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008881
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008882 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8883 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008884 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008885 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8886 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008887
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008888 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8889 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8890 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008891
8892 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8893 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008894 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8895 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8896 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008897
8898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8900
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008901 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008902
8903
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008904option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008905 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008907 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008908 Arguments :
8909 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8910 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8911 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008912 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008913 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008914
8915 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8916 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8917 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8918 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8919 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8920 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8921 ports.
8922
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008923 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8924 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008925
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008926 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008928 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008929
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008930option httpslog
8931 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8933 yes | yes | yes | no
8934
8935 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8936 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8937 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8938 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8939 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8940 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8941 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8942
8943 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8944
8945 See also : section 8 about logging.
8946
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008947
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008948option independent-streams
8949no option independent-streams
8950 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8952 yes | yes | yes | yes
8953 Arguments : none
8954
8955 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8956 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8957 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8958 receive data or not.
8959
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008960 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008961 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8962 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8963 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8964 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8965 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8966 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8967 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8968 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8969 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8970 socket buffers.
8971
8972 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8973 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8974 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8975 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8976 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8977
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008978 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008979
8980
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008981option ldap-check
8982 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8984 yes | no | yes | yes
8985 Arguments : none
8986
8987 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8988 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8989 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8990 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8991
8992 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8993 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8994
8995 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8996 configure it.
8997
8998 Example :
8999 option ldap-check
9000
9001 See also : "option httpchk"
9002
9003
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009004option external-check
9005 Use external processes for server health checks
9006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | no | yes | yes
9008
9009 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9010 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9011 command".
9012
9013 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9014
9015 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9016
9017
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009018option log-health-checks
9019no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009020 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9022 yes | no | yes | yes
9023 Arguments : none
9024
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009025 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9026 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9027 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009028
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009029 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9030 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9031 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9032 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9033 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9034
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009035 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009036 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009037
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009038 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9039 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9040 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009041
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009042
9043option log-separate-errors
9044no option log-separate-errors
9045 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9047 yes | yes | yes | no
9048 Arguments : none
9049
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009050 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009051 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9052 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9053 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9054 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9055 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9056 provides very important information.
9057
9058 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9059 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9060 error logs.
9061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009062 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009063 logging.
9064
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009065
9066option logasap
9067no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009068 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9070 yes | yes | yes | no
9071 Arguments : none
9072
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009073 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9074 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9075 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9076 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9077
9078 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9079 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9080 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9081 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9082 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009083 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009084 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9085 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9086 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9087 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009088 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009089
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009090 Examples :
9091 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9092 mode http
9093 option httplog
9094 option logasap
9095 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9096
9097 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9098 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9099 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9100 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009102 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009103 logging.
9104
9105
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009106option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009107 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9109 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009110 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009111 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9112 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009113 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9114 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009115
9116 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9117 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009118 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009119 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009120 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9121 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9122 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009123
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009124 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9125 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9126 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009127
9128 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009129 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009130 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9131 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9132 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9133 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9134 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9135 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9136 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9137
9138 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9139 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009140
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009141 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009142
9143 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9144 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9145 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9146 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009147 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009148 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009149
9150 See also: "option httpchk"
9151
9152
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009153option nolinger
9154no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009155 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9157 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009158 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009159
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009160 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009161 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9162 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9163 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9164 connections.
9165
9166 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9167 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009168 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9169 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9170 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9171 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9172 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9173 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9174 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9175 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9176 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9177 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9178 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9179 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9180 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009181
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009182 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9183 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9184 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9185 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9186 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009187
9188 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9189 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009190 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009191 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009192 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009193
9194 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9195 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9196
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009197 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9198 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009199
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009200option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9201 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9203 yes | yes | yes | yes
9204 Arguments :
9205 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9206 matching <network>
9207 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9208 header name.
9209
9210 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9211 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9212 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9213 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9214 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9215 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9216 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9217 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9218 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9219 possible that the client has already brought one.
9220
9221 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9222 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9223 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9224 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9225 header and requires different one.
9226
9227 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9228 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9229 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009230 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9231 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9232 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9233 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9234 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009235
9236 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9237 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9238 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9239 both are defined.
9240
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009241 Examples :
9242 # Original Destination address
9243 frontend www
9244 mode http
9245 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9246
9247 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9248 backend www
9249 mode http
9250 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9251
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009252 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009253
9254
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009255option persist
9256no option persist
9257 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9259 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009260 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009261
9262 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9263 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9264 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9265 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9266 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9267 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9268 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9269 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9270 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9271 redirected to another valid server.
9272
9273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9275
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009276 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009277
9278
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009279option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9280 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9282 yes | no | yes | yes
9283 Arguments :
9284 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9285 PostgreSQL server.
9286
9287 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9288 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9289 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9290 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9291
9292 See also: "option httpchk"
9293
9294
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009295option prefer-last-server
9296no option prefer-last-server
9297 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9298 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9299 yes | no | yes | yes
9300 Arguments : none
9301
9302 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009303 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009304 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9305 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009306 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009307 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009308 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009309 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9310 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009311 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009312 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009313 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9314 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9315 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009316 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9317 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9318 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009319
9320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9322
9323 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9324
9325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009326option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009327option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009328no option redispatch
9329 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9331 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009332 Arguments :
9333 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9334 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9335 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009336 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009337 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009338 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009339 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9340 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9341 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009343
9344 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9345 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9346 be able to access the service anymore.
9347
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009348 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9349 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009350
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009351 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9352 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9353 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9354 following order:
9355
9356 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9357
9358 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9359 list, or
9360
9361 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9362
9363 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9364 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9365
9366 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9367 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9368 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9369 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9370
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009371 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009372 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9373 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9377
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009378 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009379
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009380
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009381option redis-check
9382 Use redis health checks for server testing
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9384 yes | no | yes | yes
9385 Arguments : none
9386
9387 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9388 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9389 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9390 find the "+PONG" response message.
9391
9392 Example :
9393 option redis-check
9394
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009395 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009396
9397
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009398option smtpchk
9399option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9400 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9402 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009403 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009404 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009405 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009406 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9407
9408 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9409 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9410 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9411
9412 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9413 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9414 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9415 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9416 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9417 dead server.
9418
9419 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9420 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009421 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009422 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9423
9424 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9425 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9426 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9427 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009428 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009429
9430 Example :
9431 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9432
9433 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009436option socket-stats
9437no option socket-stats
9438
9439 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9441 yes | yes | yes | no
9442
9443 Arguments : none
9444
9445
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009446option splice-auto
9447no option splice-auto
9448 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 yes | yes | yes | yes
9451 Arguments : none
9452
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009453 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009454 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009455 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009456 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009457 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009458 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9459 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9460 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9461 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9462
9463 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9464 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9465 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9466 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9467 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9468 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9469 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9470 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9471 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9472 keyword.
9473
9474 Example :
9475 option splice-auto
9476
9477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9479
9480 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9481 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9482
9483
9484option splice-request
9485no option splice-request
9486 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9488 yes | yes | yes | yes
9489 Arguments : none
9490
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009491 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009492 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009493 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9494 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9495 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9496 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9497
9498 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9499
9500 Example :
9501 option splice-request
9502
9503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9505
9506 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9507 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9508
9509
9510option splice-response
9511no option splice-response
9512 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9514 yes | yes | yes | yes
9515 Arguments : none
9516
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009517 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009518 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009519 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9520 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9521 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9522 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9523
9524 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9525
9526 Example :
9527 option splice-response
9528
9529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9531
9532 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9533 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9534
9535
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009536option spop-check
9537 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9539 no | no | no | yes
9540 Arguments : none
9541
9542 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9543 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9544 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9545 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9546
9547 Example :
9548 option spop-check
9549
9550 See also : "option httpchk"
9551
9552
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009553option srvtcpka
9554no option srvtcpka
9555 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 yes | no | yes | yes
9558 Arguments : none
9559
9560 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9561 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009562 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009563 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9564
9565 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9566 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9567 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9568 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9569
9570 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9571 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9572 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9573 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9574 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9575
9576 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9577
9578 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9579 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9580 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9581
9582 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9583 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9584
9585 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9586
9587
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009588option ssl-hello-chk
9589 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9591 yes | no | yes | yes
9592 Arguments : none
9593
9594 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9595 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9596 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9597 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9598 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9599 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9600 hello message.
9601
9602 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9603 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9604 messages, which is appreciable.
9605
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009606 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009607 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9608 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009609
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009610 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9611
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009612
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009613option tcp-check
9614 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9615 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9616 yes | no | yes | yes
9617
9618 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9619 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9620
9621 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9622 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9623 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9624
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009625 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009626 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9627 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9628 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9629 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9630 only.
9631
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009632 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009633 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009634 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9635 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9636 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9637
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009638 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009639 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9640 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009641 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009642 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9643 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9644 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9645 the respective protocols.
9646 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009647 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009648
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009649 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009650
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009651 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9652 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9653 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9654 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009655
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009656 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9657 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9658 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009659
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009660
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009661 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009662 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009663 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009664 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009666 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009667 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009668 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009669
9670 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9671 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009672 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009673 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009674 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009675 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009676 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009677 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009678 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9679 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009680 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009681 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9682 tcp-check expect string +OK
9683
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009684 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009685 (send many headers before analyzing)
9686 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009687 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009688 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9689 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9690 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9691 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009692 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009693
9694
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009695 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009696
9697
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009698option tcp-smart-accept
9699no option tcp-smart-accept
9700 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9702 yes | yes | yes | no
9703 Arguments : none
9704
9705 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9706 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9707 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9708 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9709 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9710 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9711
9712 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9713 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9714 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9715 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9716
9717 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9718 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9719 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009720 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009721
9722 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9723 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9724 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9725
9726 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9727 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9728 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9729
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009730 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9731
9732
9733option tcp-smart-connect
9734no option tcp-smart-connect
9735 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9737 yes | no | yes | yes
9738 Arguments : none
9739
9740 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9741 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9742 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9743 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9744 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9745
9746 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9747 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9748 complex.
9749
9750 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9751 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9752 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9753
9754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9756
9757 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9758
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009759
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009760option tcpka
9761 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9763 yes | yes | yes | yes
9764 Arguments : none
9765
9766 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9767 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009768 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009769 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9770
9771 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9772 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9773 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9774 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9775
9776 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9777 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9778 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9779 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9780 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9781
9782 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9783
9784 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9785 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9786 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9787 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9788 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9789 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9790 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9791 backends.
9792
9793 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9794
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009795
9796option tcplog
9797 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009799 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009800 Arguments : none
9801
9802 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9803 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9804 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9805 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9806 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9807 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9808 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9809 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9810
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009811 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009813 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009814
9815
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009816option transparent
9817no option transparent
9818 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009820 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009821 Arguments : none
9822
9823 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9824 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9825 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9826 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9827 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9828 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9829 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9830 appropriate server.
9831
9832 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9833 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9834
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009835 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009836 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009837
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009838
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009839external-check command <command>
9840 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9842 yes | no | yes | yes
9843
9844 Arguments :
9845 <command> is the external command to run
9846
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009847 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9848
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009849 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009850
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009851 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9852 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9853 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9854 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9855 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9856 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009857
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009858 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9859
9860 Environment variables :
9861 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9862 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9863
9864 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9865
9866 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9867
9868 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9869 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9870 for a UNIX socket).
9871
9872 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9873
9874 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9875
9876 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9877
9878 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9879
9880 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9881
9882 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9883 socket).
9884
9885 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9886 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9887
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009888 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9889
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009890 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9891 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9892 failed.
9893
9894 Example :
9895 external-check command /bin/true
9896
9897 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9898
9899
9900external-check path <path>
9901 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9903 yes | no | yes | yes
9904
9905 Arguments :
9906 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9907
9908 The default path is "".
9909
9910 Example :
9911 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9912
9913 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9914 "external-check command"
9915
9916
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009917persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009918persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009919 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9921 yes | no | yes | yes
9922 Arguments :
9923 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009924 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9925 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009926
9927 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9928 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009929 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009930 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9931 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9932 forwarded to this server.
9933
9934 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9935 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9936 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009937 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009938 a single "listen" section.
9939
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009940 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9941 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9942 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9943
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009944 Example :
9945 listen tse-farm
9946 bind :3389
9947 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9948 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9949 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9950 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9951 persist rdp-cookie
9952 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009953 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009954 balance rdp-cookie
9955 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9956 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9957
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009958 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9959 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009960
9961
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009962rate-limit sessions <rate>
9963 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9965 yes | yes | yes | no
9966 Arguments :
9967 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9968 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9969
9970 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9971 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9972 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009973 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009974 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9975 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9976
9977 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9978 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9979 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9980 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9981
9982 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9983 listen smtp
9984 mode tcp
9985 bind :25
9986 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009987 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009988
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009989 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9990 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9991 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009992
9993 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9994
9995
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009996redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9997redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9998redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009999 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10001 no | yes | yes | yes
10002
10003 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010004 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010005
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010006 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010007 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010008 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10009 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10010 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010011
10012 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10013 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10014 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10015 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10016 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010017 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10018 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10019 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10020 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010021
10022 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10023 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10024 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10025 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10026 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10027 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010028 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010029 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010030 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10031 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10032 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010033
10034 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010035 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10036 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10037 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010038 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010039 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10040 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10041 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10042 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010043
10044 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010045 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010046
10047 - "drop-query"
10048 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10049 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10050 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10051 with a location-type redirect.
10052
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010053 - "append-slash"
10054 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10055 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10056 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10057 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10058
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010059 - "ignore-empty"
10060 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10061 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10062 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10063 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10064 of known paths using a simple map.
10065
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010066 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10067 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10068 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10069 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10070 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10071 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10072 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10073
10074 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10075 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10076 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10077 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10078 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10079 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10080 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010081
10082 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10083 acl clear dst_port 80
10084 acl secure dst_port 8080
10085 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010086 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010087 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010088 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10089
10090 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010091 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10092 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10093 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010094 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010095
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010096 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10097 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10098 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10099
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010100 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010101 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010102
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010103 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010104 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10105 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10106 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010107
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010108 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10109 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10110 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010113
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010114
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010115retries <value>
10116 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10118 yes | no | yes | yes
10119 Arguments :
10120 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10121 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10122 default value is 3.
10123
10124 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10125 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10126 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10127
10128 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010129 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10130 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010131
10132 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10133 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10134
10135 See also : "option redispatch"
10136
10137
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010138retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010139 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10140 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10141 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010142 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10143 yes | no | yes | yes
10144 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010145 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10146 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10147 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10148 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10149 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010150
10151 none never retry
10152
10153 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10154 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10155
10156 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10157 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10158 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10159 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10160 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10161 processing the request.
10162
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010163 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10164 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10165 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10166 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10167 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10168 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10169 overflow attack for example).
10170
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010171 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10172 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10173 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10174 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10175 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10176 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10177 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10178 amplify denial of service attacks.
10179
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010180 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10181 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10182 considered to be safe to retry.
10183
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010184 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10185 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10186 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10187 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10188 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010189
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010190 all-retryable-errors
10191 retry request for any error that are considered
10192 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10193 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10194 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10195
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010196 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10197 not cumulative.
10198
10199 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10200 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10201 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10202 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10203
10204 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10205 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10206 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10207 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10208 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10209 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10210 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10211 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10212 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10213 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10214 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10215 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10216
10217 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10218 should not use this directive.
10219
10220 The default is "conn-failure".
10221
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010222 Example:
10223 retry-on 503 504
10224
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010225 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10226
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010227server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010228 Declare a server in a backend
10229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10230 no | no | yes | yes
10231 Arguments :
10232 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010233 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010234 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010235
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010236 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10237 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10238 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10239 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010240 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10241 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010242 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010243 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10244 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010245 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10246 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10247 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10248 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10249 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10250 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10251 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010252 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010253 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10254 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10255 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10256 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10257 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10258 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010259 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10260 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010261 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10262 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010263
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010264 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010265 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10266 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10267 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10268 adding this value to the client's port.
10269
10270 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10271 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010272 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010273
10274 Examples :
10275 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10276 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010277 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010278 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10279 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10280 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010281
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010282 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10283 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10284 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10285 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10286 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10287
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010288 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10289 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010290
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010291server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010292 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010293 this backend.
10294 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10295 no | no | yes | yes
10296
10297 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10298 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10299 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10300 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10301 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010302
10303 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10304 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10305
10306 global
10307 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10308
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010309 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010310 load-server-state-from-file
10311
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010312 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010313 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010314
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010315server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10316 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10317 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10319 no | no | yes | yes
10320
10321 Arguments:
10322 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10323
10324 <num | range>
10325 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10326 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10327 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10328 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10329
10330 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10331
10332 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10333
10334 <params*>
10335 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10336 keyword.
10337
10338 Examples:
10339 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10340 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10341 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10342
10343 # or
10344 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10345
10346 # would be equivalent to:
10347 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10348 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10349 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10350
10351
10352
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010353source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010354source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010355source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10358 yes | no | yes | yes
10359 Arguments :
10360 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10361 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010362
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010363 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010364 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10365 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10366 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10367 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10368 supported prefixes are :
10369 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10370 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10371 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010372 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010373 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10374 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010375
10376 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10377 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010378 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10379 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10380 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010381
10382 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10383 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10384 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10385 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10386 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10387 <addr>.
10388
10389 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10390 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10391 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10392 port.
10393
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010394 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10395 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10396 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10397 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010398 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010399 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10400 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10401 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10402 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10403 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10404 HTTP header.
10405
10406 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10407 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010408 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010409 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10410 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10411 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10412 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10413 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10414 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10415 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10416
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010417 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10418 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10419 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10420 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10421 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10422 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10423
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010424 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10425 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10426 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10427 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10428
10429 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10430 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10431 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10432 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10433 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10434 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10435
10436 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10437 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10438 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10439 there are two methods :
10440
10441 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10442 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10443 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10444 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10445 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10446 of the client ranges may be used.
10447
10448 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10449 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10450 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10451 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10452 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10453 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10454 same session.
10455
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010456 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10457 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10458 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010459 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010460
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010461 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10462
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010463 Examples :
10464 backend private
10465 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10466 source 192.168.1.200
10467
10468 backend transparent_ssl1
10469 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10470 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10471
10472 backend transparent_ssl2
10473 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10474 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10475 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10476
10477 backend transparent_ssl3
10478 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10479 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10480 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10481
10482 backend transparent_smtp
10483 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10484 # with Tproxy version 4.
10485 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10486
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010487 backend transparent_http
10488 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10489 # proxy.
10490 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010492 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010493 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10494
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010495
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010496srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10497 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10498 the connection on the server side.
10499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10500 yes | no | yes | yes
10501 Arguments :
10502 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10503
10504 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10505 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010506 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10507 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010508
10509 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10510
10511
10512srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10513 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10514 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10515 server side.
10516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10517 yes | no | yes | yes
10518 Arguments :
10519 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10520 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10521 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10522 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10523
10524 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10525 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010526 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10527 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010528
10529 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10530
10531
10532srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10533 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10535 yes | no | yes | yes
10536 Arguments :
10537 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10538 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10539 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10540 document.
10541
10542 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10543 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010544 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10545 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010546
10547 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10548
10549
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010550stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10551 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010553 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010554
10555 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10556 matched.
10557
10558 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10559 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10560
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010561 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10562 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10563 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10564 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010565
10566 Example :
10567 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10568 backend stats_localhost
10569 stats enable
10570 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10571
10572 Example :
10573 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10574 backend stats_auth
10575 stats enable
10576 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10577 stats admin if TRUE
10578
10579 Example :
10580 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10581 userlist stats-auth
10582 group admin users admin
10583 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10584 group readonly users haproxy
10585 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10586
10587 backend stats_auth
10588 stats enable
10589 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10590 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10591 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10592 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10593
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010594 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10595 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010596
10597
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010598stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10599 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010601 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010602 Arguments :
10603 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10604
10605 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10606
10607 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10608 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10609 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10610 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10611 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10612 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10613
10614 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10615 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10616 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010617 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010618
10619 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10620 report using "stats scope".
10621
10622 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10623 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10624 unobvious parameters.
10625
10626 Example :
10627 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10628 backend public_www
10629 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10630 stats enable
10631 stats hide-version
10632 stats scope .
10633 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010634 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010635 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10636 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10637
10638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10639 backend private_monitoring
10640 stats enable
10641 stats uri /admin?stats
10642 stats refresh 5s
10643
10644 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10645
10646
10647stats enable
10648 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010650 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010651 Arguments : none
10652
10653 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10654 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10655 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10656 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10657 - stats auth : no authentication
10658 - stats scope : no restriction
10659
10660 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10661 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10662 unobvious parameters.
10663
10664 Example :
10665 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10666 backend public_www
10667 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10668 stats enable
10669 stats hide-version
10670 stats scope .
10671 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010672 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010673 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10674 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10675
10676 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10677 backend private_monitoring
10678 stats enable
10679 stats uri /admin?stats
10680 stats refresh 5s
10681
10682 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10683
10684
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010685stats hide-version
10686 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010688 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010689 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010690
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010691 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10692 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10693 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10694 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10695 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10696 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010698 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10699 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10700 unobvious parameters.
10701
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010702 Example :
10703 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10704 backend public_www
10705 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010706 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010707 stats hide-version
10708 stats scope .
10709 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010710 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010711 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10712 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010713
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010714 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10715 backend private_monitoring
10716 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010717 stats uri /admin?stats
10718 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010719
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010720 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010721
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010722
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010723stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10724 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10725 Access control for statistics
10726
10727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10728 no | no | yes | yes
10729
10730 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10731 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10732 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10733 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10734 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10735 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10736
10737 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10738 instance.
10739
10740 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10741 about ACL usage.
10742
10743
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010744stats realm <realm>
10745 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010747 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010748 Arguments :
10749 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10750 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10751 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10752
10753 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10754 using a backslash ('\').
10755
10756 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10757 only related to authentication.
10758
10759 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10760 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10761 unobvious parameters.
10762
10763 Example :
10764 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10765 backend public_www
10766 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10767 stats enable
10768 stats hide-version
10769 stats scope .
10770 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010771 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010772 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10773 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10774
10775 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10776 backend private_monitoring
10777 stats enable
10778 stats uri /admin?stats
10779 stats refresh 5s
10780
10781 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10782
10783
10784stats refresh <delay>
10785 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010787 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010788 Arguments :
10789 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10790 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10791 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10792 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10793 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10794 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10795
10796 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10797 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10798 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010799 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010800
10801 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10802 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10803 unobvious parameters.
10804
10805 Example :
10806 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10807 backend public_www
10808 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10809 stats enable
10810 stats hide-version
10811 stats scope .
10812 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010813 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010814 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10815 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10816
10817 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10818 backend private_monitoring
10819 stats enable
10820 stats uri /admin?stats
10821 stats refresh 5s
10822
10823 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10824
10825
10826stats scope { <name> | "." }
10827 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010829 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010830 Arguments :
10831 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10832 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10833 section in which the statement appears.
10834
10835 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10836 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10837 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10838 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10839 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10840 exists.
10841
10842 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10843 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10844 unobvious parameters.
10845
10846 Example :
10847 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10848 backend public_www
10849 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10850 stats enable
10851 stats hide-version
10852 stats scope .
10853 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010854 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010855 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10856 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10857
10858 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10859 backend private_monitoring
10860 stats enable
10861 stats uri /admin?stats
10862 stats refresh 5s
10863
10864 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10865
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010866
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010867stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010868 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010870 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010871
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010872 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010873 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10874
10875 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10876 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10877
10878 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10879 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010880 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010881
10882 Example :
10883 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10884 backend private_monitoring
10885 stats enable
10886 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10887 stats uri /admin?stats
10888 stats refresh 5s
10889
10890 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10891 global section.
10892
10893
10894stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010895 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10897 yes | yes | yes | yes
10898 Arguments : none
10899
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010900 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010901 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10902 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10903 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10904 - IP (socket, server)
10905 - cookie (backend, server)
10906
10907 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10908 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010909 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010910
10911 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10912
10913
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010914stats show-modules
10915 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10917 yes | yes | yes | yes
10918 Arguments : none
10919
10920 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10921 values as a tooltip.
10922
10923 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10924 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10925 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10926
10927 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10928
10929
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010930stats show-node [ <name> ]
10931 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010933 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934 Arguments:
10935 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10936 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10937
10938 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10939 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010940 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941
10942 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10943 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10944 unobvious parameters.
10945
10946 Example:
10947 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10948 backend private_monitoring
10949 stats enable
10950 stats show-node Europe-1
10951 stats uri /admin?stats
10952 stats refresh 5s
10953
10954 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10955 section.
10956
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010957
10958stats uri <prefix>
10959 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010961 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010962 Arguments :
10963 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10964 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10965 query string.
10966
10967 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10968 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10969 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10970 possible to reach it in the application.
10971
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010972 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010973 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010974 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10975 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10976 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10977 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10978
10979 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10980 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10981 an address or a port to statistics only.
10982
10983 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10984 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10985 unobvious parameters.
10986
10987 Example :
10988 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10989 backend public_www
10990 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10991 stats enable
10992 stats hide-version
10993 stats scope .
10994 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010996 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10997 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10998
10999 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11000 backend private_monitoring
11001 stats enable
11002 stats uri /admin?stats
11003 stats refresh 5s
11004
11005 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11006
11007
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011008stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11009 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011012
11013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011014 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011015 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011016 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011017 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11018
11019 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11020 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11021 the "stick-table" statement.
11022
11023 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11024 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11025 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11026 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11027 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11028
11029 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11030 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11031 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11032 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11033 transformation rules.
11034
11035 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11036 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11037 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11038 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11039 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11040 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11041 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11042
11043 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11044 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11045 ACL based conditions.
11046
11047 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11048 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11049 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11050 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11051
11052 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11053 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11054 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11055 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11056
11057 Example :
11058 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11059 # last 30 minutes
11060 backend pop
11061 mode tcp
11062 balance roundrobin
11063 stick store-request src
11064 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11065 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11066 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11067
11068 backend smtp
11069 mode tcp
11070 balance roundrobin
11071 stick match src table pop
11072 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11073 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11074
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011075 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11076 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011077
11078
11079stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11080 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11082 no | no | yes | yes
11083
11084 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11085 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11086 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11087 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11088
11089 Examples :
11090 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011091 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011092
11093 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11094 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11095 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11096
11097
11098 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11099 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11100 backend http
11101 mode http
11102 balance roundrobin
11103 stick on src table https
11104 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11105 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11106 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11107
11108 backend https
11109 mode tcp
11110 balance roundrobin
11111 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11112 stick on src
11113 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11114 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11115
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011116 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011117
11118
11119stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11120 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11122 no | no | yes | yes
11123
11124 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011125 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011126 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011128 server is selected.
11129
11130 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11131 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11132 the "stick-table" statement.
11133
11134 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11135 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11136 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11137 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11138 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11139 address.
11140
11141 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11142 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11143 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11144 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11145 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11146 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11147 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11148 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11149 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11150 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11151
11152 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11153 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11154 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11155 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11156 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11157 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11158 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11159
11160 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11161 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11162 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11163 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11164
11165 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11166 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11167 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11168 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11169 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11170 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011171 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11172 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11173 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11174 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11175 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11176 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011177
11178 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11179 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11180 the request.
11181
11182 Example :
11183 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11184 # last 30 minutes
11185 backend pop
11186 mode tcp
11187 balance roundrobin
11188 stick store-request src
11189 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11190 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11191 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11192
11193 backend smtp
11194 mode tcp
11195 balance roundrobin
11196 stick match src table pop
11197 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11198 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11199
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011200 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011201
11202
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011203stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011204 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011205 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011206 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011208 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011209
11210 Arguments :
11211 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11212 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11213 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11214 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11215
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011216 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11217 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11218 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11219 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11220
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011221 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11222 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11223 instance.
11224
11225 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11226 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11227 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11228 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11229 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11230 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011231 to 32 characters.
11232
11233 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11234 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11235 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011236 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011237 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11238 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011239
11240 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011241 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11242 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011243 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11244 increase.
11245
11246 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011247 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11248 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11249 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011250
11251 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011252 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011253 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11254 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011255 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011256 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11257 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11258 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11259 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11260 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11261 parameter (see below).
11262
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011263 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11264 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11265 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11266 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11267 soft restart.
11268
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011269 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11270 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11271 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11272 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011273 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011274 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011275 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11276 if not expiration delay is specified.
11277
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011278 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11279 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11280 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11281 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11282 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11283 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11284 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11285 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11286 token.
11287
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011288 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11289 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11290 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11291 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011292 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11293 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11294 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11295 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11296 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11297 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11298 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11299 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11300 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11301 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11302 types and their arguments.
11303
11304 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11305 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11306 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11307 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11308
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011309 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11310 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11311 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11312 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11313 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11314 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11315 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11316 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11317 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11318 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011319 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11320 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11321 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11322 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011323
11324 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11325 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11326 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11327 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11328 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11329 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11330 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11331 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11332 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11333 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11334 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11335 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011336 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11337 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11338 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11339 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011340
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011341 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11342 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11343 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011344 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011345
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011346 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11347 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11348 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011349 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011350 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011351 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011352
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011353 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11354 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11355 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11356 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11357
11358 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11359 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11360 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11361 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11362 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11363 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11364
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011365 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11366 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11367 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11368 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11369 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11370 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11371 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11372 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11373 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11374 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011375 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11376 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11377 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011378
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011379 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11380 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11381 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11382 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11383
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011384 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11385 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11386 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11387 they were received.
11388
11389 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11390 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11391 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11392 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11393 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11394
11395 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11396 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11397 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11398 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11399 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11400
11401 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11402 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11403 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11404
11405 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11406 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11407 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11408 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11409 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11410
11411 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11412 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11413 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11414 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11415 the client side.
11416
11417 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11418 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11419 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11420 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11421 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11422 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11423 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11424
11425 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11426 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11427 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11428 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11429 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11430 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011431 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011432
11433 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11434 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11435 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11436 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11437 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11438 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11439
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011440 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11441 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11442 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11443 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11444 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11445
11446 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11447 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11448 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11449 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11450 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11451 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11452
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011453 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011454 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011455 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11456 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11457
11458 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11459 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11460 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11461 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11462 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11463 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11464 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11465 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11466 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11467 recommended for better fairness.
11468
11469 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011470 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011471 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11472 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11473
11474 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11475 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11477 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11478 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11479 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11480 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11481 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11482 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11483 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011484
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011485 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11486 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011487 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11488 reference it.
11489
11490 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11491 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011492 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11493 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11494 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011495
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011496 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11497 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11498 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11499 something that can be ignored.
11500
11501 Example:
11502 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11503 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11504 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11505 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11506
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011507 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011508 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011509
11510
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011511stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011512 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11514 no | no | yes | yes
11515
11516 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011517 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011518 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011520 server is selected.
11521
11522 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11523 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11524 the "stick-table" statement.
11525
11526 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11527 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11528 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11529 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11530
11531 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11532 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11533 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11534 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11535 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11536 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011537 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011538 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11539 rules.
11540
11541 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11542 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11543 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11544 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11545 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11546 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11547 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11548
11549 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11550 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11551 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11552 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11553
11554 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11555 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11556 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11557 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11558 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11559 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011560 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11561 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11562 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11563 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11564 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11565 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11566 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11567 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11568 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011569
11570 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11571
11572 Example :
11573 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11574 backend https
11575 mode tcp
11576 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011577 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011578 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011579
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011580 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11581 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11582
11583 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11584 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11585 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11586
11587 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11588 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011589
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011590 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11591 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11592 # at offset 44.
11593
11594 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11595 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11596
11597 # Learn on response if server hello.
11598 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011599
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011600 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11601 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11602
11603 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11604 extraction.
11605
11606
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011607tcp-check comment <string>
11608 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11609 it fails.
11610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11611 yes | no | yes | yes
11612
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011613 Arguments :
11614 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11615 rule fails.
11616
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011617 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11618 user-friendly error reporting.
11619
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011620 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11621 "tcp-check expect".
11622
11623
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011624tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11625 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011626 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011627 Opens a new connection
11628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011629 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011630
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011631 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011632 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11633
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011634 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011635 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011636
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011637 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011638 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11639 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011640 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011641
11642 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011643
11644 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11645
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011646 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11647
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011648 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11649
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011650 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11651
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011652 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11653 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11654 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11655 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11656
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011657 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11658 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11659 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11660 haproxy -vv.
11661
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011662 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011663
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011664 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11665 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11666 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11667
11668 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11669 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11670 of the sequence.
11671
11672 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11673 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11674 do.
11675
11676 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11677 unset-var or comment rules.
11678
11679 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011680 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11681 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11682 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11683 option tcp-check
11684 tcp-check connect
11685 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11686 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11687 tcp-check send \r\n
11688 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11689 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11690 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11691 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11692 tcp-check send \r\n
11693 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11694 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11695
11696 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11697 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011698 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011699 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11700 tcp-check connect port 143
11701 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11702 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11703
11704 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11705
11706
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011707tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011708 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011709 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011710 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011711 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011713 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011714
11715 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011716 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11717
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011718 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11719 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11720 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11721 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11722 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11723 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11724 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11725 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11726 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11727 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11728
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011729 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011730 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11731 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011732 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11733 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11734 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11735
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011736 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11737 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11738 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011739 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11740 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011741 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11742 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011743 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11744 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011745 By default "L7OK" is used.
11746
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011747 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11748 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011749 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11750 supported :
11751 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11752 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011753 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11754 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11755 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11756 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11757 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011758
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011759 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011760 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011761 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11762 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11763 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11764 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011765 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11766
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011767 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11768 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11769 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11770 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11771
11772 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11773 informational message reported in logs if an error
11774 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11775 log-format string.
11776
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011777 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11778 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11779 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11780 followed by some converters.
11781
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011782 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11783 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11784 with the usual backslash ('\').
11785 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011787 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11788 used upper or lower case.
11789
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011790 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11791
11792 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11793 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11794 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11795 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11796 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11797 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11798 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11799 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11800
11801 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11802 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11803 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11804 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11805 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11806 expression.
11807
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011808 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11809 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11810 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11811 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11812 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11813 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11814
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011815 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11816 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11817 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11818 this exact hexadecimal string.
11819 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11820
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011821 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11822 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11823 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11824 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11825 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11826 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11827 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11828 size.
11829
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011830 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11831 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11832 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11833 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11834 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11835 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11836 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11837 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11838 in a binary string before matching the response's
11839 buffer.
11840
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011841 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011842 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011843 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11844 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11845 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11846 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11847 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11848 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11849 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11850 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11851 the null character.
11852
11853 Examples :
11854 # perform a POP check
11855 option tcp-check
11856 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11857
11858 # perform an IMAP check
11859 option tcp-check
11860 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11861
11862 # look for the redis master server
11863 option tcp-check
11864 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011865 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011866 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11867 tcp-check expect string role:master
11868 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11869 tcp-check expect string +OK
11870
11871
11872 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011873 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011874
11875
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011876tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11877tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11878 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11879 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011882
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011883 Arguments :
11884 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11885
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011886 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11887 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011888
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011889 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11890 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011891
11892 Examples :
11893 # look for the redis master server
11894 option tcp-check
11895 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11896 tcp-check expect string role:master
11897
11898 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011899 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011900
11901
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011902tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11903tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11904 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11905 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011907 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011908
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011909 Arguments :
11910 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011911
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011912 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11913 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011914
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011915 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11916 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11917 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011918
11919 Examples :
11920 # redis check in binary
11921 option tcp-check
11922 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11923 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11924
11925
11926 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011927 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928
11929
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010011930tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
11931tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011932 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011934 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011935
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011936 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011937 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11938 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11939 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11940 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11941 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11943 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11944 and '-'.
11945
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010011946 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
11947 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
11948 set-var converter's decription for a full list of possible
11949 conditions.
11950
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011951 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11952
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011953 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
11954 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
11955
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011956 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011957 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011958 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011959
11960
11961tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011962 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011964 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011965
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011966 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011967 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11968 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11969 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11970 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11971 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11973 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11974 and '-'.
11975
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011976 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011977 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11978
11979
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020011980tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011981 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020011983 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011985 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11986 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011988 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011989
11990 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11991 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011992 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11993 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11994 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11995 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11996 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11997 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011999 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12000 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12001 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012002 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12003 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12004 is true.
12005
12006 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12007 supported:
12008 - accept
12009 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12010 - expect-proxy layer4
12011 - reject
12012 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12013 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12014 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12015 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12016 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12017 - set-dst <expr>
12018 - set-dst-port <expr>
12019 - set-mark <mark>
12020 - set-src <expr>
12021 - set-src-port <expr>
12022 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012023 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12024 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012025 - silent-drop
12026 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12027 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12028 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012029 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012030
12031 The supported actions are described below.
12032
12033 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12034 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012035
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012036 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12037 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12038 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12039 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12040 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12041 a defaults section defining such rules.
12042
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012043 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12044 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12045 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012046
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012047 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12048 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12049 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012050
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012051 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12052 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12053 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012054
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012055 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12056 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12057 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012058
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012059 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12060 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12061 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012062
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012063 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012064
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012065 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012066
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012067 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012068
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012069 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012070
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012071tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012072
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012073 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12074 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012075
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012076tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12077 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012078
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012079 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12080 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12081 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12082 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12083 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12084 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12085 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012086
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012087tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012088
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012089 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12090 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12091 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12092 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12093 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12094 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012095
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012096tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012097
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012098 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12099 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12100 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12101 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12102 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12103 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12104 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12105 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12106 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12107 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12108 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012109
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012110tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12111tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12112tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012113
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012114 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12115 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12116 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12117 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012118
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012119tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12120 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12121tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12122 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012123
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012124 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12125 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12126 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012127
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012128tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12129tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012130
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012131 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12132 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12133 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012134
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012135tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012136
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012137 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12138 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12139 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012140
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012141tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12142tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012143
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012144 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12145 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12146 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012147
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012148tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012149
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012150 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12151 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12152 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012153
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012154tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12155tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012156
12157 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12158 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12159 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12160 for a complete description.
12161
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012162tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012163
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012164 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12165 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12166 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12167 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012168
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012169tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12170tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12171tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012172
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012173 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12174 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12175 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012176
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012177tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12178
12179 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12180 details about variables.
12181
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012182
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012183tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12184 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012186 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012187 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012188 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12189 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012191 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012193 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012194 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12195 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012196 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12197 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012199 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12200 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12201 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12202 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012203 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012204 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012205 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12206 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12207 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12208 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012209 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012210 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012212 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12213 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12214 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12215 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012216
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012217 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12218 supported:
12219 - accept
12220 - capture <sample> len <length>
12221 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12222 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012223 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012224 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012225 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012226 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012227 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012228 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012229 - set-dst <expr>
12230 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012231 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012232 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012233 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012234 - set-priority-class <expr>
12235 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012236 - set-src <expr>
12237 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012238 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012239 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12240 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012241 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012242 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012243 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12244 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12245 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012246 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012247 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012248
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012249 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012250
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012251 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12252 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12253 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12254 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12255 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12256 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012257
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012258 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12259 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12260 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12261 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12262 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12263 a defaults section defining such rules.
12264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012265 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012266 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12267 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012268
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012269 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12270 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12271 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12272 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12273 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12274 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012276 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012277 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12278 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12279 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12280 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12281 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12282 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12283 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12284 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12285 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12286 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012287
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012288 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012289 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12290 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12291 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012292
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012293 Example:
12294 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12295
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012296 Example:
12297
12298 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012299 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012300 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012301
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012302 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012303 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012304 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012305 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12306 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012307 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012308 tcp-request content reject
12309
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012310 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12311 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12312 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12313 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12314 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12315 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12316 ...
12317 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12318
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012319 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012320 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12321 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12322 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012323 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012324
12325 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12326 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12327 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012328 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012329 tcp-request content reject
12330
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012331 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012332 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012333 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012334 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012335 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12336 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012337
12338 Example:
12339 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12340 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012341 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012343 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012344 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012345
12346 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012347 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012348 # protecting all our sites
12349 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012350 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12351 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012352 ...
12353 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12354
12355 backend http_dynamic
12356 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012357 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012358 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012359 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012360 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012361 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012362 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012364 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012365
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012366 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12367 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012368
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012369tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12370
12371 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012372 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012373
12374tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12376
12377 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12378 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12379 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12380 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12381 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12382 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12383 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12384 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12385 information.
12386
12387tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12388
12389 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12390 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12391 complete description.
12392
12393tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12394
12395 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12396 are evaluated.
12397
12398tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12399tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12400tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12401
12402 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12403 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12404 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12405 description.
12406
12407tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12409tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12411
12412 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12413 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12414 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12415
12416tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12417 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12418
12419 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12420 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12421
12422tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12423tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12424
12425 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12426 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12427 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12428
12429tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12430
12431 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12432 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12433
12434tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12435
12436 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12437 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12438 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12439
12440tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12441
12442 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12443 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12444
12445tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12446
12447 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12448 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12449
12450tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12451
12452 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12453 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12454 description.
12455
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012456tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12457tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12458
12459 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12460 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12461 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12462
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012463tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12464
12465 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12466 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12467 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12468
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012469tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12470tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012471
12472 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12473 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12474 for a complete description.
12475
12476tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12477
12478 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12479 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12480 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12481 complete description.
12482
12483tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12485
12486 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12487 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12488 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12489 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12490 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12491 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12492 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12493 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12494 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12495 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12496
12497 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12498
12499tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12500tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12501tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12502
12503 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12504 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12505 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12506
12507tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12508
12509 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12510 details about variables.
12511
12512tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12513
12514 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12515 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12516 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12517 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12518 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12519
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012520
12521tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12522 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012524 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012525 Arguments :
12526 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12528 as explained at the top of this document.
12529
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012530 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012531 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12532 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12533 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12534 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12535
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012536 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12537 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12538 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12539 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12540
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012541 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012542 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012543 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012544 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012545 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012546 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12547 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12548 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012549
12550 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12551 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12552 it pass through unaffected.
12553
12554 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12555 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12556 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012557 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012558 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12559 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012560 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12561 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12562 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012563
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012564 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12565 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12566
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012567 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012568 "timeout client".
12569
12570
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012571tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12572 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012574 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012575 Arguments :
12576 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12577 below.
12578
12579 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12580
12581 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12582 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12583 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12584 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012585 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012586 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12587 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12588 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12589 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12590 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12591 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12592 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12593 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12594 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12595 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12596 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12597 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12598 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12599 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12600 instead.
12601
12602 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12603 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12604 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12605 rules which may be inserted.
12606
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012607 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12608 supported:
12609 - accept
12610 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012611 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12612 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12613 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12614 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12615 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012616 - set-dst <expr>
12617 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012618 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012619 - set-src <expr>
12620 - set-src-port <expr>
12621 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012622 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12623 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012624 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012625 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12626 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12627 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12628 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012629
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012630 The supported actions are described below.
12631
12632 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12633 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12634 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12635 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12636 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12637 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012638
12639 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12640 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12641 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12642
12643 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12644 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12645 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12646 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12647 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12648
12649 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12650 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12651
12652 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12653 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12654 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12655
12656 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12657 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12658 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12659
12660 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12661 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12662 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12663
12664 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12665 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12666 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12667
12668 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12669
12670 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12671
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012672tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12673
12674 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12675 rules are evaluated.
12676
12677tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12678
12679 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12680 are evaluated.
12681
12682tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12683tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12684tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12685
12686 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12687 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12688 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12689 description.
12690
12691tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12692 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12693tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12695
12696 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12697 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12698 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12699 description.
12700
12701tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12702tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12703
12704 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12705 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12706 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12707
12708tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12709
12710 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12711 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12712 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12713
12714tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12715tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12716
12717 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12718 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12719 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12720
12721tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12722
12723 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12724 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12725 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12726
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012727tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12728tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012729
12730 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12731 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12732 for a complete description.
12733
12734tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12735
12736 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12737 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12738 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12739 complete description.
12740
12741tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12742tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12743tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12744
12745 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12746 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12747 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12748
12749tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12750
12751 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12752 details about variables.
12753
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012754
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012755tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12756 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012758 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012759 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012760 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12761 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012762
12763 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12764
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012765 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012766 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12767 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012768 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12769 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012770
12771 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12772
12773 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12774 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12775 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12776 inserted.
12777
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012778 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12779 supported:
12780 - accept
12781 - close
12782 - reject
12783 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12784 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12785 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12786 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12787 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12788 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12789 - set-log-level <level>
12790 - set-mark <mark>
12791 - set-nice <nice>
12792 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012793 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12794 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012795 - silent-drop
12796 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12797
12798 The supported actions are described below.
12799
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012800 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12801 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12802 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12803 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12804 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12805 a defaults section defining such rules.
12806
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012807 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12808 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12809 for changing the default action to a reject.
12810
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012811 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012812
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012813 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12814 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12815 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12816 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
12817 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012818
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012819 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012820
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012821 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012822
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012823tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012824
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012825 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12826 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012827
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012828tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012829
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012830 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
12831 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
12832 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
12833 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
12834 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
12835 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012836
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012837tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012838
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012839 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12840 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012841
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012842tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12843tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12844tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012845
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012846 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12847 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12848 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12849 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012850
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012851tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12852 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12853tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12854 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012855
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012856 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12857 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12858 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012859
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012860tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012862
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012863 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12864 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012865
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012866tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012867
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012868 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12869 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012870
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012871tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012872
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012873 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12874 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12875 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012876
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012877tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012878
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012879 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12880 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012881
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012882tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012883
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012884 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12885 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12886 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012887
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012888tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12889tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012890
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012891 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12892 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12893 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012894
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012895tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012896
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012897 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12898 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12899 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12900 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012901
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012902tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012903
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012904 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12905 details about variables.
12906
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012907
12908tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12909 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012911 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012912 Arguments :
12913 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12914 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12915 as explained at the top of this document.
12916
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012917 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12918 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012919
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012920 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12921
12922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012923timeout check <timeout>
12924 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12925 established.
12926
12927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12928 yes | no | yes | yes
12929 Arguments:
12930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12932 as explained at the top of this document.
12933
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012934 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012935 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012936 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012937 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012938 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12939 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12940 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012941
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012942 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012943 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12944
12945 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12946 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012947 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012948
12949 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12950 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12951 forget about it.
12952
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012953 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12954 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12955
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012956 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12957 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012958
12959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012960timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012961 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12963 yes | yes | yes | no
12964 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012965 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012966 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12967 as explained at the top of this document.
12968
12969 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12970 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12971 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012972 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12973 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12974 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12975 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012976 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12977 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12978 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012979 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012980 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012981 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12982 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012983 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12984 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012985
12986 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12987 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12988 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12989 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012990 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012991 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12992
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012993 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012994
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012995 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012997
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012998timeout client-fin <timeout>
12999 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13001 yes | yes | yes | no
13002 Arguments :
13003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13005 as explained at the top of this document.
13006
13007 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13008 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13009 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13010 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13011 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13012 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13013 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013014 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13015 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13016 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013017
13018 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13019 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13020 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13021
13022 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13023
13024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013025timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013026 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13028 yes | no | yes | yes
13029 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013030 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13032 as explained at the top of this document.
13033
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013034 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013035 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013036 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013038 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13039 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013040
13041 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13042 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13043 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13044 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013045 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013046 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13047
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013048 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013050
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013051timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13052 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13054 yes | yes | yes | yes
13055 Arguments :
13056 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13057 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13058 as explained at the top of this document.
13059
13060 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13061 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13062 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13063 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13064 once the request has started to present itself.
13065
13066 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13067 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13068 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13069 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13070 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13071
13072 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13073 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13074 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13075 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13076
13077 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13078 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013079 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013080 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13081 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013082 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013083
13084 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13085 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13086 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13087 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13088
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013089 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
13090 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013091 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
13092
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013093 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13094
13095
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013096timeout http-request <timeout>
13097 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013102 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13103 as explained at the top of this document.
13104
13105 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13106 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13107 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13108 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13109 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13110 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13111 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013112 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13113 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13114 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13115 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013116 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013117 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13118 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013119
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013120 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13121 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13122 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13123 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13124 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013125 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013126
13127 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13128 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013129 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013130 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13131 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13132
13133 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013134 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13135 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13136 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013137
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013138 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013139 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013140
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013141
13142timeout queue <timeout>
13143 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13145 yes | no | yes | yes
13146 Arguments :
13147 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13148 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13149 as explained at the top of this document.
13150
13151 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13152 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13153 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13154 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13155 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13156
13157 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13158 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13159 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13160 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13161
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013162 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013163
13164
13165timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013166 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13168 yes | no | yes | yes
13169 Arguments :
13170 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13171 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13172 as explained at the top of this document.
13173
13174 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13175 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13176 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13177 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13178 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13179 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13180 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13181
13182 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13183 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13184 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13185 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13186 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013187 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013188 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013189 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13190 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013191 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13192 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013193
13194 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13195 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13196 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13197 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013198 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013199 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13200
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013201 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013202
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013203
13204timeout server-fin <timeout>
13205 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13207 yes | no | yes | yes
13208 Arguments :
13209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13211 as explained at the top of this document.
13212
13213 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13214 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13215 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13216 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13217 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13218 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13219 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13220 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13221 situations, it should not be needed.
13222
13223 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13224 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13225 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13226
13227 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13228
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013229
13230timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013231 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13233 yes | yes | yes | yes
13234 Arguments :
13235 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13236 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13237 as explained at the top of this document.
13238
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013239 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13240 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13241 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013242
13243 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13244 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13245 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13246 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013247 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013248
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013249 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013250
13251
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013252timeout tunnel <timeout>
13253 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13255 yes | no | yes | yes
13256 Arguments :
13257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13259 as explained at the top of this document.
13260
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013261 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013262 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13263 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13264 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13266 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013267 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13268 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13269 specified.
13270
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013271 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13272 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13273 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13274 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13275 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13276 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13277 state.
13278
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013279 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13280 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13281 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13282 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013283 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013284
13285 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13286 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13287 forget about it.
13288
13289 Example :
13290 defaults http
13291 option http-server-close
13292 timeout connect 5s
13293 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013294 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013295 timeout server 30s
13296 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13297
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013298 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013299
13300
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013301transparent (deprecated)
13302 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013304 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013305 Arguments : none
13306
13307 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13308 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13309 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13310 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13311 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13312 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13313 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13314 appropriate server.
13315
13316 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13317
13318 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13319 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13320
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013321 See also: "option transparent"
13322
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013323unique-id-format <string>
13324 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13326 yes | yes | yes | no
13327 Arguments :
13328 <string> is a log-format string.
13329
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013330 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13331 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13332 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13333 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013334
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013335 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013336 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013337 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13338 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13339 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13340 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13341 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13342 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013343
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013344 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13345 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013346
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013347 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013348
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013349 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013350
13351 will generate:
13352
13353 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13354
13355 See also: "unique-id-header"
13356
13357unique-id-header <name>
13358 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13360 yes | yes | yes | no
13361 Arguments :
13362 <name> is the name of the header.
13363
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013364 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13365 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013366
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013367 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013368
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013369 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013370 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13371
13372 will generate:
13373
13374 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13375
13376 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013377
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013378use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013379 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13381 no | yes | yes | no
13382 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013383 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13384 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013385
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013386 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13387 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013388
13389 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13390 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13391 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013392 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013393 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013394 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13395 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013396
13397 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13398 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13399 assign the backend.
13400
13401 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13402 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13403 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13404 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13405 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13406 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13407
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013408 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013409 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013410 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13411 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13412 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13413
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013414 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13415 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13416 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13417 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13418 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13419 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13420 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13421 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13422 cannot be forced from the request.
13423
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013424 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013425 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13426 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13427
13428 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13429 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013430
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013431use-fcgi-app <name>
13432 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13434 no | no | yes | yes
13435 Arguments :
13436 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13437
13438 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013439
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013440use-server <server> if <condition>
13441use-server <server> unless <condition>
13442 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13444 no | no | yes | yes
13445 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013446 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13447 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013448
13449 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13450
13451 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13452 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13453 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13454
13455 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13456 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13457 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13458 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13459 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13460 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13461 matches will assign the server.
13462
13463 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13464 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13465 with the next rules until one matches.
13466
13467 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13468 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13469 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13470 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13471
13472 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13473 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13474 stripped.
13475
13476 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13477 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013478 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013479 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013480 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013481
13482 Example :
13483 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013484 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013485 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013486 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013487 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013488 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013489 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013490 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13491 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13492
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013493 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13494 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13495 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13496 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013497 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013498 and we fall back to load balancing.
13499
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013500 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013501
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013502
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135035. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013504--------------------------
13505
13506The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13507depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13508settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13509written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13510described in this section.
13511
13512
135135.1. Bind options
13514-----------------
13515
13516The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13517as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13518no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13519parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13520while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13521provided immediately after the setting name.
13522
13523The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13524
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013525accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13526 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13527 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13528 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13529 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13530 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13531 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13532 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13533 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13534 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013535 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13536 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13537 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013538
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013539accept-proxy
13540 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013541 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13542 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013543 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13544 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13545 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13546 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013547 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013548 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13549 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013550 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13551 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013552
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013553allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013554 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013555 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013556 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013557 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13558 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013559
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013560alpn <protocols>
13561 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13562 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13563 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013564 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013565 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013566 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13567 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13568 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13569 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13570 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13571 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13572 preference, like below :
13573
13574 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013575
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013576backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013577 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013578 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13579
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013580curves <curves>
13581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13582 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13583 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13584 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13585 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13586 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13587
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013588ecdhe <named curve>
13589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013590 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13591 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013592
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013593ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13595 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13596 client's certificate.
13597
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013598ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13599 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13600 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13601 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13602 error is ignored.
13603
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013604ca-sign-file <cafile>
13605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13606 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13607 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13608 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13609 'generate-certificates' for details.
13610
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013611ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13613 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13614 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13615 'generate-certificates' for details.
13616
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013617ca-verify-file <cafile>
13618 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13619 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13620 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13621 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13622 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13623
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013624ciphers <ciphers>
13625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13626 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013627 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013628 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013629 information and recommendations see e.g.
13630 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13631 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13632 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13633
13634ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13636 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13637 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13638 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013639 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13640 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013641
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013642crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13644 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013645 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13646 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013647
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013648crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13650 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13651 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13652 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13653 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013654 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13655 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013656
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013657 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13658 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13659
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013660 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13661 are loaded.
13662
13663 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013664 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13665 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13666 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13667 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13668 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13669 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13670 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013671 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013672
13673 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13674 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13675 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13676 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013677 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13678 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013679
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013680 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013681
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013682 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013683 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013684 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13685 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013686 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13687 clients).
13688
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013689 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013690 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13691 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13692 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13693 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13694 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13695 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13696 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13697 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13698 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13699 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13700 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13701 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13702
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013703 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013704 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13705 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13706 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13707 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13708
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013709 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13710 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13711 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13712 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013713
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013714 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13715 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13716 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013717
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013718crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013720 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013721 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013722 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013723
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013724crt-list <file>
13725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013726 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13727 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013728
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013729 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13730
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013731 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13732 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13733 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13734 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13735 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013736
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013737 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013738 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13739 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13740 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13741 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13742 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013743 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13744 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13745 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013746
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013747 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13748 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13749 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013750
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013751 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13752
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013753 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013754 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013755 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13756 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13757 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13758 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13759 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13760 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013761
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013762 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013763 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013764 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013765 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013766 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013767 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013768
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013769defer-accept
13770 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13771 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13772 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013773 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013774 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13775 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13776 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13777 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13778 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13779 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13780 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13781
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013782expose-fd listeners
13783 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13784 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010013785 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
13786 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013787 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013788
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013789force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013790 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013791 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013792 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013793 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013794
13795force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013796 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013797 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013798 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013799
13800force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013801 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013802 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013803 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013804
13805force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013806 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013807 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013808 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013809
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013810force-tlsv13
13811 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13812 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013813 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013814
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013815generate-certificates
13816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13817 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13818 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13819 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13820 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13821 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13822 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13823 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13824 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13825 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13826 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13827
13828 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13829 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013831 certificate is used many times.
13832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013833gid <gid>
13834 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13835 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13836 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13837 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13838 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13839
13840group <group>
13841 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13842 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13843 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13844 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13845 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13846
13847id <id>
13848 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13849 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13850 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13851 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13852
13853interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013854 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13855 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13856 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13857 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13858 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13859 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013860 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13861 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13862 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13863 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13864 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13865 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013866
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013867level <level>
13868 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13869 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13870 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013871 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013872 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13873 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13874 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013875 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013876 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013877 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013878 all counters).
13879
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013880severity-output <format>
13881 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13882 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13883 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13884 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13885 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13886 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13887 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13888 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13889 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13890 rfc5424 convention.
13891
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013892maxconn <maxconn>
13893 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13894 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13895 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13896 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13897 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13898 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13899 eat all memory.
13900
13901mode <mode>
13902 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13903 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13904 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13905 UNIX sockets.
13906
13907mss <maxseg>
13908 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13909 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13910 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13911 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13912 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13913 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13914 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13915 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13916 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13917 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13918 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13919
13920name <name>
13921 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13922 page.
13923
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013924namespace <name>
13925 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13926 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13927 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13928 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013930nice <nice>
13931 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13932 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13933 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13934 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13935 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13936 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13937 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13938 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13939 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13940 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13941 one for an RDP socket.
13942
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013943no-ca-names
13944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13945 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013946 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013947
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013948no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013950 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013951 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013952 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013953 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13954 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013955
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013956no-tls-tickets
13957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13958 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13959 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013960 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13961 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013962 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13963 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13964 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013965
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013966no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013967 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013968 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013969 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013970 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013971 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13972 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013973
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013974no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013976 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013977 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013978 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013979 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13980 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013982no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013984 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013985 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013986 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013987 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13988 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013989
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013990no-tlsv13
13991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13992 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13993 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13994 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013995 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13996 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013997
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013998npn <protocols>
13999 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14000 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14001 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014002 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014003 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014004 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14005 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14006 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14007 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14008 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014009
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014010prefer-client-ciphers
14011 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14012 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14013 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014014 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14015 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14016 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014017
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014018process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014019 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14020 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14021 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14022 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14023 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14024 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014025
14026 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14027
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014028 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014029 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14030 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14031 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14032 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14033 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014034
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014035 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14036 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14037
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014038proto <name>
14039 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14040 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14041 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014042 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14043 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14044
14045 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14046 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14047 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14048 also reported (flag=HTX).
14049
14050 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14051 a bind line :
14052
14053 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14054 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14055 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14056
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014057 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014058 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014059 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014060 h2" on the bind line.
14061
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014062shards <number> | by-thread
14063 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14064 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14065 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14066 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14067 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14068 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14069 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14070 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14071 little bit.
14072
14073 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14074 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14075 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14076 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14077 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14078 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014080ssl
14081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014082 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014083 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14084 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014085 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14086 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014087
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014088ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14089 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014090 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14091 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14092 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014093 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14094
14095ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014096 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14097 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14098 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14099 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014100
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014101strict-sni
14102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14103 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14104 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14105 See the "crt" option for more information.
14106
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014107tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014108 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014109 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014110 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014111 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014112 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14113 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14114 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14115 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14116 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14117 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14118 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14119
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014120tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014121 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014122 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14123 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14124 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14125 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14126 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14127 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14128 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014129 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14130 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14131 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014132
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014133thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014134 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14135 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14136 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014137
14138 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14139 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14140 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14141 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14142 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14143 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14144 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14145 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14146 of the parsing.
14147
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014148 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014149 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14150 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014151
14152 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14153
14154 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14155 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14156 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14157 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14158 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14159 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14160
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014161tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14162 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014163 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14164 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14165 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14166 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14167 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14168 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14169 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14170 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14171 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14172 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014173 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14174 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14175
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014176transparent
14177 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14178 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14179 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14180 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14181 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14182 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14183 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14184 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14185 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14186 so check for support with your vendor.
14187
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014188v4v6
14189 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14190 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14191 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14192 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014193 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014194
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014195v6only
14196 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14197 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14198 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014199 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14200 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014202uid <uid>
14203 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14204 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14205 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14206 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14207 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14208
14209user <user>
14210 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14211 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14212 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14213 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14214 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14215
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014216verify [none|optional|required]
14217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14218 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14219 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14220 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14221 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014222 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14223 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14224 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14225 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014226
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200142275.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014228------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014230The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14231which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14232arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14233settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14234after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14235Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14236address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014238 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014239 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014240
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014241Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14242keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014244The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014245
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014246addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014247 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014248 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14249 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14250 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14251 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14252 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014253
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014254agent-check
14255 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014256 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014257 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14258 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14259 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014260
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014261 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014262 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014263 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014264 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14265 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014266
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014267 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14268 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14269 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14270 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14271 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014272
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014273 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014274 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014275
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014276 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14277 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14278 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014279
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014280 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14281 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14282 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014283
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014284 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014285 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14286 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14287 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14288 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014289 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014290 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014291
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014292 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14293 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014294
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014295 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14296 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14297 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14298 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14299 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14300 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14301 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14302 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14303 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014304
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014305 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14306 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014307 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14308 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14309 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014310 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014311
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014312 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014313 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014314
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014315agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014316 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014317 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14318 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14319 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14320 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14321
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014322agent-inter <delay>
14323 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14324 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14325
14326 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14327 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14328 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14329 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14330 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14331 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14332 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14333 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14334 of backends use the same servers.
14335
14336 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14337
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014338agent-addr <addr>
14339 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14340
14341 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014342 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014343 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14344 hostname, it will be resolved.
14345
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014346agent-port <port>
14347 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14348
14349 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14350
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014351allow-0rtt
14352 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014353 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14354 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014355
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014356alpn <protocols>
14357 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14358 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14359 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014360 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014361 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14362 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14363 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14364 now obsolete NPN extension.
14365 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14366 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14367
14368 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14369
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014370 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014372backup
14373 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14374 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14375 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14376 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014377 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14378 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014379
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014380ca-file <cafile>
14381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14382 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14383 server's certificate.
14384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014385check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014386 This option enables health checks on a server:
14387 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14388 considered available.
14389 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14390 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14391 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14392 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14393 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14394 set.
14395 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14396 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14397 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14398 exchanges succeed.
14399
14400 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14401 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14402 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14403 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14404 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014405 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014406 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14407
14408 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14409 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14410
14411 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14412 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14413
14414 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14415 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14416 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14417 available.
14418
14419 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14420 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14421 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14422
14423 Example:
14424 # simple tcp check
14425 backend foo
14426 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14427 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14428 backend foo
14429 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14430 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14431 backend foo
14432 option tcp-check
14433 tcp-check connect
14434 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014435
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014436check-send-proxy
14437 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14438 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14439 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14440 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14441 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14442 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14443 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14444
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014445check-alpn <protocols>
14446 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14447 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14448 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14449
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014450check-proto <name>
14451 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14452 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14453 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014454 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14455 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14456
14457 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14458 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14459 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14460 also reported (flag=HTX).
14461
14462 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14463 directive on a server line:
14464
14465 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14466 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14467 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14468 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14469
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014470 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014471 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14472 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14473
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014474check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014475 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014476 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14477 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014478
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014479check-ssl
14480 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14481 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14482 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14483 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014484 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014485 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14486 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014487 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014488 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14489 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014490
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014491check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014492 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014493 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14494 for normal traffic.
14495
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014496ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14498 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14499 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014500 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14501 information and recommendations see e.g.
14502 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14503 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14504 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014505
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014506ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14508 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14509 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14510 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014511 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14512 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14513 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014515cookie <value>
14516 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14517 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14518 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14519 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14520 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14521 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14522 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14523
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014524crl-file <crlfile>
14525 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14526 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14527 to verify server's certificate.
14528
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014529crt <cert>
14530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14531 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14532 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14533 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14534 certificate request.
14535
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014536 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14537 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14538 option is set accordingly).
14539
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014540disabled
14541 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14542 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14543 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14544 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14545 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014546 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014547
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014548enabled
14549 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14550 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14551 default value.
14552 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14553 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014555error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014556 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14557 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14558 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014560 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014562fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014563 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14564 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14565 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14566
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014567force-sslv3
14568 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14569 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014570 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014571 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014572
14573force-tlsv10
14574 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014575 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014576 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014577
14578force-tlsv11
14579 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014580 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014581 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014582
14583force-tlsv12
14584 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014585 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014586 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014587
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014588force-tlsv13
14589 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14590 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014591 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014593id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014594 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14595 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14596 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014597
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014598init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14599 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14600 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014601 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014602 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14603 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14604 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14605 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14606 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14607 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14608 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14609 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14610 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014611 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014612 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14613 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14614 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14615 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14616 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14617 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014618 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014619
14620 Example:
14621 defaults
14622 # never fail on address resolution
14623 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014625inter <delay>
14626fastinter <delay>
14627downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014628 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14629 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14630 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14631 between checks depending on the server state :
14632
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014633 Server state | Interval used
14634 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14635 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14636 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14637 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14638 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14639 or yet unchecked. |
14640 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14641 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14642 | "inter" otherwise.
14643 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014645 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14646 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14647 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14648 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014649 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14650 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14651 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14652 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14653 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014654
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014655log-proto <logproto>
14656 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14657 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14658 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14659 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014661maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014662 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14663 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014664 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14665 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014666 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14667 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14668 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14669 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14670
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014671 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14672 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14673 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14674 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14675 than 50 concurrent requests.
14676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014677maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014678 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14679 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14680 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14681 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014682 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14683 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14684 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14685 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14686 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14687 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14688 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014689
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014690max-reuse <count>
14691 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14692 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14693 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14694 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14695 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14696 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14697 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14698 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014700minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014701 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14702 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14703 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14704 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14705 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14706 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014707 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014708 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014709
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014710namespace <name>
14711 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14712 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14713 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14714 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14715
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014716no-agent-check
14717 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14718 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14719 default value.
14720 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14721 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14722
14723no-backup
14724 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14725 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14726 default value.
14727 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14728 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14729
14730no-check
14731 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14732 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14733 default value.
14734 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14735 "default-server" "check" setting.
14736
14737no-check-ssl
14738 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14739 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14740 default value.
14741 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14742 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14743
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014744no-send-proxy
14745 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14746 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14747 default value.
14748 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14749 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14750
14751no-send-proxy-v2
14752 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14753 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14754 default value.
14755 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14756 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14757
14758no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14759 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14760 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14761 default value.
14762 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14763 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14764
14765no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14768 default value.
14769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14770 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14771
14772no-ssl
14773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14775 default value.
14776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14777 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14778
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014779 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14780 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14781 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14782
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014783no-ssl-reuse
14784 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14785 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14786 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14787 and for paranoid users.
14788
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014789no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014790 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14791 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014792 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014793
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014794 Supported in default-server: No
14795
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014796no-tls-tickets
14797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14798 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14799 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014800 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14801 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014802 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14803 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14804 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014805 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014806
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014807no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014808 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014809 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14810 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014811 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14812 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014813 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014814
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014815 Supported in default-server: No
14816
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014817no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014818 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014819 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14820 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014821 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14822 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014823 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014824
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014825 Supported in default-server: No
14826
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014827no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014828 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014829 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14830 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014831 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14832 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014833 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014834
14835 Supported in default-server: No
14836
14837no-tlsv13
14838 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14839 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14840 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14841 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14842 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014843 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014844
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014845 Supported in default-server: No
14846
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014847no-verifyhost
14848 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14849 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14850 default value.
14851 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14852 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014853
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014854no-tfo
14855 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14856 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14857 default value.
14858 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14859 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14860
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014861non-stick
14862 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14863 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14864 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14865
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014866npn <protocols>
14867 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14868 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14869 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014870 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014871 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14872 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14873 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014875observe <mode>
14876 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14877 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14878 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14879 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14880 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14881 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014882 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014883
14884 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014886on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014887 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14888 Currently, four modes are available:
14889 - fastinter: force fastinter
14890 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14891 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14892 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14893 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14894
14895 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14896
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014897on-marked-down <action>
14898 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14899 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014900 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14901 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14902 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14903 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14904 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14905 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14906 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14907 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014908
14909 Actions are disabled by default
14910
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014911on-marked-up <action>
14912 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14913 Currently one action is available:
14914 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14915 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14916 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14917 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014918 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14919 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014920 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14921 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14922
14923 Actions are disabled by default
14924
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014925pool-low-conn <max>
14926 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14927 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14928 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14929 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14930 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14931 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14932 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14933 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14934 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14935 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014936 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14937 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14938 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14939 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014940
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014941pool-max-conn <max>
14942 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14943 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14944 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14945 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14946 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14947 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14948
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014949pool-purge-delay <delay>
14950 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014951 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014952 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014954port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014955 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014956 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14957 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14958 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14959 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14960 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014961
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014962proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014963 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14964 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14965 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014966 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14967 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14968
14969 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14970 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14971 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14972 also reported (flag=HTX).
14973
14974 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14975 a server line :
14976
14977 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14978 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14979 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14980 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14981
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014982 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014983 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14984
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014985 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014987redir <prefix>
14988 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14989 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14990 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14991 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14992 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14993 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14994 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14995 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014996 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014997 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014998 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14999 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15000 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15001 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15002
15003 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015005rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015006 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15007 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15008 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15009
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015010resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15011 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15012 server.
15013
15014 Available options:
15015
15016 * allow-dup-ip
15017 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15018 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15019 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15020 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15021 For such case, simply enable this option.
15022 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15023
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015024 * ignore-weight
15025 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15026 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15027 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15028
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015029 * prevent-dup-ip
15030 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15031 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15032 same fqdn.
15033 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15034
15035 Example:
15036 backend b_myapp
15037 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15038 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15039 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15040
15041 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15042 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15043 it
15044 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15045 different address
15046
15047 Default value: not set
15048
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015049resolve-prefer <family>
15050 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15051 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15052 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15053 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15054
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015055 Default value: ipv6
15056
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015057 Example:
15058
15059 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015060
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015061resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015062 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015063 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015064 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015065 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15066 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015067 configured network, another address is selected.
15068
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015069 Example:
15070
15071 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015072
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015073resolvers <id>
15074 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15075 hostname.
15076
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015077 Example:
15078
15079 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015080
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015081 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015082
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015083send-proxy
15084 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15085 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15086 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15087 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015088 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15089 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15090 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15091 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015092 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015093 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15094 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15095 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15096 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15097 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015098 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15099 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015100
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015101send-proxy-v2
15102 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15103 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15104 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15105 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015106 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15107 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15108 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15109 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015110
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015111proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015112 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15113 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15114
15115 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15116 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15117 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15118 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15119 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15120 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15121 connection is supported).
15122 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15123 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15124 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15125 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15126 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15127 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15128 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015129
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015130send-proxy-v2-ssl
15131 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15132 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15133 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15134 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15135 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15136 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15137 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015138 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15139 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015140
15141send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15142 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15143 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15144 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15145 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15146 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15147 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15148 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15149 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015150 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15151 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015153slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015154 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15155 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15156 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15157 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15158 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15159 parameters :
15160
15161 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15162 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15163
15164 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15165 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15166 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15167 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015169 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015170 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15171 seen as failed.
15172
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015173sni <expression>
15174 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15175 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15176 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15177 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015178 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15179 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015180 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015181 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15182 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015183
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015184source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015185source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015186source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015187 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15188 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15189 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15190 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15191
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015192 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15193 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15194 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15195 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15196 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15197 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15198 server.
15199
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015200 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15201 specifying the source address without port(s).
15202
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015203ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015204 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15205 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15206 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15207 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15208 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15209 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015210 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15211 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015212
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015213ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15214 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15215 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15216 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15217
15218ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15219 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15220 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15221 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15222
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015223ssl-reuse
15224 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15225 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15226 default value.
15227 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15228 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15229
15230stick
15231 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15232 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15233 default value.
15234 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15235 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015236
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015237socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015238 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015239 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15240 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15241
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015242tcp-ut <delay>
15243 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015244 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015245 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015246 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015247 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15248 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15249 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15250 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15251 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15252 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15253 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15254 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15255 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15256
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015257tfo
15258 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15259 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15260 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15261 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015262 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015263 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015265track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015266 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15267 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15268 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15269 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015270 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15271
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015272tls-tickets
15273 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15274 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15275 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015276 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15277 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15278 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015279 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015280 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015281
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015282verify [none|required]
15283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015284 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015285 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15286 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015287 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015288 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15289 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15290 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15291 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15292 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15293 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15294 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15295 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015296
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015297verifyhost <hostname>
15298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015299 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15300 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15301 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15302 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15303 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15304 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15305 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15306 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015308weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015309 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15310 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15311 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015312 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15313 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15314 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15315 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15316 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15317 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015318
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015319ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15320 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15321 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15322 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15323
15324 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15325 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15326 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15327 server ALPN contains it.
15328
15329 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15330 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15331 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15332 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15333
15334 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15335 favor of the ALPN extension.
15336
15337 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015339
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153405.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15341-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015342
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015343HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15344using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015345configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015346This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15347can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15348workload.
15349This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15350resolution at run time.
15351Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15352carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15353
15354
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153555.3.1. Global overview
15356----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015357
15358As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15359different steps of the process life:
15360
15361 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15362 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15363 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15364
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015365 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15366 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015367
15368A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15369 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15370 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15371 resolution to know this new IP.
15372
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015373When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015374HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015375SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15376from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015377will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015378will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015379
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015380A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015381 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015382 first valid response.
15383
15384 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15385 servers return an error.
15386
15387
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153885.3.2. The resolvers section
15389----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015390
15391This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015392HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15393contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015394
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015395When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15396uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15397is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15398answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15399
15400When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015401used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015402
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015403 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15404 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15405 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015406
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015407 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15408 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015409
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015410 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15411 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15412 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015413
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015414For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15415following scenarios are possible:
15416
15417 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15418 ignored
15419
15420 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15421 applied
15422
15423 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15424 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15425
15426 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15427 retries the query with a new type
15428
15429 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15430 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015431
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015432As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015433a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015434<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015435
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015436
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015437resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015438 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015439
15440A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15441
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015442accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015443 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015444 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015445 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15446 by RFC 6891)
15447
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015448 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15449 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15450 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15451 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15452 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15453 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015454
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015455nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15456 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15457 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15458 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15459 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15460 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15461 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15462 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15463 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15464 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015465 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15466
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015467parse-resolv-conf
15468 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15469 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15470 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15471
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015472hold <status> <period>
15473 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15474 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015475 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015476 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015477 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15478 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15479 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15480
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015481 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015482
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015483resolve_retries <nb>
15484 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15485 giving up.
15486 Default value: 3
15487
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015488 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15489 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15490 type.
15491
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015492timeout <event> <time>
15493 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15494 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15495 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015496 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15497 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015498 Default value: 1s
15499 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015500 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015501 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015502 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15503 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15504
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015505 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015506
15507 resolvers mydns
15508 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15509 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015510 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015511 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015512 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015513 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015514 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015515 hold other 30s
15516 hold refused 30s
15517 hold nx 30s
15518 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015519 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015520 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015521
15522
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200155236. Cache
15524---------
15525
15526HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15527(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15528RAM.
15529
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015530The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15531blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015532
15533If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15534independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15535when we try to allocate a new one.
15536
15537The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15538
15539It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15540"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15541for more details.
15542
15543When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15544replaced by "<CACHE>".
15545
15546
155476.1. Limitation
15548----------------
15549
15550The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15551
15552- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015553- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15554 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15555 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015556- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15557- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015558- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15559 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15560 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015561- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15562 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015563- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15564 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15565 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015566
15567- If the request is not a GET
15568- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15569- If the request contains an Authorization header
15570
15571
155726.2. Setup
15573-----------
15574
15575To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15576the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15577
15578
155796.2.1. Cache section
15580---------------------
15581
15582cache <name>
15583 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15584 size of cache is mandatory.
15585
15586total-max-size <megabytes>
15587 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15588 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15589
15590max-object-size <bytes>
15591 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15592 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15593 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15594
15595max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015596 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015597 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15598 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15599 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15600 default.
15601
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015602process-vary <on/off>
15603 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015604 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15605 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15606 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015607 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015608
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015609max-secondary-entries <number>
15610 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15611 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15612 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15613
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015614
156156.2.2. Proxy section
15616---------------------
15617
15618http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15619 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15620 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15621 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15622 after this one.
15623
15624http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15625 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15626 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15627 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15628 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15629
15630
15631Example:
15632
15633 backend bck1
15634 mode http
15635
15636 http-request cache-use foobar
15637 http-response cache-store foobar
15638 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15639
15640 cache foobar
15641 total-max-size 4
15642 max-age 240
15643
15644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156457. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15646----------------------------------
15647
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015648HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15650The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15651these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15652but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15653data called patterns.
15654
15655
156567.1. ACL basics
15657---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015658
15659The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15660content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15661from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15662simple :
15663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015665 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15667 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15670adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015671
15672In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015675
15676This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15677Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15678and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015679an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15680conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15681as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15682are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015683
15684ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15685'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15686which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15687
15688There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15689performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15692specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15693this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015694methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15695ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696
15697Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15698 - boolean
15699 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15700 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15701 - string
15702 - data block
15703
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015704Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15705converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15706would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15707The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15708which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15709
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015710Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15711keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15712fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15713which are summarized in the table below :
15714
15715 +---------------------+-----------------+
15716 | Sample or converter | Default |
15717 | output type | matching method |
15718 +---------------------+-----------------+
15719 | boolean | bool |
15720 +---------------------+-----------------+
15721 | integer | int |
15722 +---------------------+-----------------+
15723 | ip | ip |
15724 +---------------------+-----------------+
15725 | string | str |
15726 +---------------------+-----------------+
15727 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15728 +---------------------+-----------------+
15729
15730Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15731matching method, see below.
15732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15734 - boolean
15735 - integer or integer range
15736 - IP address / network
15737 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15738 - regular expression
15739 - hex block
15740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015741The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15742
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015743 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15744 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015746 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015747 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015748 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015749 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15752read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15753if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15754lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15755will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15756beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015757a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015758lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15759exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15760
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015761The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15762parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15763ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15764a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15765check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15766
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015767The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15768socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15769file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15772loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15773
15774 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15775
15776In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15777the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15778case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15779as well.
15780
15781The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15782sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15783do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15784methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15785is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015786obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15788default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15789that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15790string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15791
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015792The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15793By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15794string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15795resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015796server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015797waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015798flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15799function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15802sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15803be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015804
15805 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15806 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15808 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15809 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15810 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015811
15812 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15813 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015815
15816 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015818
15819 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015821
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015822 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015823 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15824
15825 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15826 binary or string samples.
15827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15829 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15832 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15833 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015835 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15836 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015838 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15839 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15842 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15845 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015846 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15849 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15850 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015851
15852For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15853request, it is possible to do :
15854
15855 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15856
15857In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15858buffer, one would use the following acl :
15859
15860 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15861
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015862On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15863possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15864
15865 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15868criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15869method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15870to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15871criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15872the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015875the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15876For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15879 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15880 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15881 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015882
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015883
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015884The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15885types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15886combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15887brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15888default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890 +-------------------------------------------------+
15891 | Input sample type |
15892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015893 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15895 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015897 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015899 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015901 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015903 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015905 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015907 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015909 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015911 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015913 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015915 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015917 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15919 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15920 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015921
15922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159237.1.1. Matching booleans
15924------------------------
15925
15926In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15927Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15928When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15929that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15930
15931Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15932return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15933"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15934
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159367.1.2. Matching integers
15937------------------------
15938
15939Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15940enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15941to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15942
15943Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15944matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15945lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015946
15947For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15948unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15949representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15950
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015951As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15952two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15953instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15954ranges and operators.
15955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015956For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015957operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15958Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15959of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015961Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015962
15963 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15964 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15965 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15966 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15967 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015969For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015970
15971 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15972
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015973This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15974
15975 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15976
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159787.1.3. Matching strings
15979-----------------------
15980
15981String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15982different forms :
15983
15984 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015985 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986
15987 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015988 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989
15990 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15991 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15992
15993 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15994 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15995
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015996 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15998 matches.
15999
16000 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16001 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16002 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016003
16004String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16005exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16006characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16007string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16008to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016009before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016010
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016011Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16012(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16013Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16014
16015Example:
16016 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16017 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160207.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16021---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016022
16023Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16024they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16025possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16026passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16027the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016028the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16029match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016030
16031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160327.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16033-------------------------------------
16034
16035It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16036not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16037a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16038to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16039digits may be used upper or lower case.
16040
16041Example :
16042 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
16043 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
16044
16045
160467.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16047---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016048
16049IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16050netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16051within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016052host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016053difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16054at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16055does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16056parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016057
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016058The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16059abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16060
16061 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16062 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16063 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16064 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16065 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16066 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16067 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16068 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16069
16070Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16071192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16072
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016073IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16074Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16075trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16076IPv6 patterns.
16077
16078HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16079following situations :
16080 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16081 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16082 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16083 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16084 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16085 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16086 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16087 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16088 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16089 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091
160927.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16093----------------------------------
16094
16095Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16096combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16097
16098 - AND (implicit)
16099 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16100 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16107indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16110"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16111requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16112is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16113
16114 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016115 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16116 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16117 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118
16119To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16120and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16121
16122 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16123 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16124 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16125 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016127 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16129 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16130 use_backend www if host_www
16131
16132It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16133expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16134be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16135the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16136
16137 The following rule :
16138
16139 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016140 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141
16142 Can also be written that way :
16143
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016144 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145
16146It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16147to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16148simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16149sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16150good use is the following :
16151
16152 With named ACLs :
16153
16154 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16155 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16156 monitor fail if site_dead
16157
16158 With anonymous ACLs :
16159
16160 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16161
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016162See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16163keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164
16165
161667.3. Fetching samples
16167---------------------
16168
16169Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16170against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16171sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16172ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16173of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16174available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16175
16176This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16177Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16178compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16179deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16180
16181The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16182matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16183method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16184indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16185
16186As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16187when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16188mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16189the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16190ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16191
16192Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16193multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16194when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016195incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16196are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16198all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16199
16200Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16201 - name
16202 - name(arg1)
16203 - name(arg1,arg2)
16204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016205
162067.3.1. Converters
16207-----------------
16208
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016209Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16210of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16211is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16212was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016213has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016214unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16215
16216These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16217sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16218the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016219support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016220
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016221A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16222support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16223supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16224(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16225bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016228
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001622951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16230 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16231 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16232 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16233 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16234 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16235
16236 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016237 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16238 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016239 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16240 frontend http-in
16241 bind *:8081
16242 default_backend servers
16243 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16244 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16245
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016246add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016247 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016248 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016249 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16250 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016251 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016252 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16253 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16254 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16255 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016256 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016257 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016258
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016259aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16260 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16261 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16262 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16263 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16264 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16265 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16266
16267 Example:
16268 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16269 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16270
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016271and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016272 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016273 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016274 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16275 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016276 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016277 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16278 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16279 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16280 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016281 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016282 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016283
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016284b64dec
16285 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16286 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016287 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16288 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016289
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016290base64
16291 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016292 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016293 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16294 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016295
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016296be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16297 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16298 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16299 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16300 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16301 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16302
16303 Example:
16304 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16305 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16306 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16307 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16308
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016309be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16310 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16311 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16312 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16313 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16314 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16315 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16316
16317 Example:
16318 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16319 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16320 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16321 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16322
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016323bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016324 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016325 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016326 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016327 presence of a flag).
16328
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016329bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16330 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16331 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016332 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016333
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016334concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16335 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16336 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16337 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16338 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16339 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16340 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16341 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16342 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16343 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16344 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016345 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016346 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016347 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016348 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16349 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16350 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016351
16352 Example:
16353 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16354 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16355 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016356 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016357 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016358 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016360cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016361 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16362 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016363
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016364crc32([<avalanche>])
16365 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16366 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16367 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16368 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16369 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16370 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16371 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16372 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16373 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16374 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016375 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16376
16377crc32c([<avalanche>])
16378 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16379 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16380 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16381 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16382 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16383 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16384 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16385 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016386
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016387cut_crlf
16388 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16389 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16390 updated.
16391
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016392da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016393 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16394 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16395 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16396 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016397 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016398 configuration language.
16399
16400 Example:
16401 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016402 bind *:8881
16403 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016404 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016405
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016406debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16407 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16408 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16409 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16410 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16411 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16412 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16413 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16414 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16415 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16416 printable sample types.
16417
16418 Example:
16419 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016420
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016421digest(<algorithm>)
16422 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16423 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16424
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016425 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016426 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16427
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016428div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016429 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16430 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016431 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016432 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16433 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016434 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016435 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16436 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16437 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016440 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016441
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016442djb2([<avalanche>])
16443 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16444 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16445 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16446 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16447 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16448 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16449 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016450 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16451 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016452
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016453even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016454 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016455 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16456
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016457field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16458 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16459 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16460 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16461 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16462 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16463 fields.
16464
16465 Example :
16466 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16467 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16468 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16469 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16470 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016471
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016472fix_is_valid
16473 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16474 Information eXchange):
16475
16476 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16477 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016478 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016479 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016480 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016481 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16482 checksum
16483
16484 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16485 the server can be parsed.
16486
16487 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16488 message, false if not.
16489
16490 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16491
16492 Example:
16493 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16494 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16495
16496fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16497 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16498 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16499 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16500 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016501 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016502 added.
16503
16504 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16505 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16506 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16507 fix_is_valid converter.
16508
16509 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16510
16511 Example:
16512 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16513 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16514 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16515 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16516 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16517
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016518hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016519 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016520 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016521 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016522 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016523
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016524hex2i
16525 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016526 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016527
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016528htonl
16529 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16530 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16531 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16532 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16533
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016534hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016535 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16536 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16537 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16538 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16539
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016540 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016541 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16542
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016543http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016544 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16545 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016546 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16547 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16548 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16549 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16550 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16551 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16552 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16553 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016555iif(<true>,<false>)
16556 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16557 string otherwise.
16558
16559 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016560 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016561
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016562in_table(<table>)
16563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16565 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016566 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016567 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16568
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016569ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016570 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016571 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016572 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16573 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16574 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16575 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16576 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016577
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016578json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016579 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016580 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016581 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016582 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16583 of errors:
16584 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16585 bytes, ...)
16586 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16587 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16588
16589 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16590 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16591 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16592 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16593 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16594 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016595 - "ascii" : never fails;
16596 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16597 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016598 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016599 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016600 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16601 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16602
16603 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016604 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016605
16606 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016607 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016608 capture request header user-agent len 150
16609 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016610
16611 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16612 GET / HTTP/1.0
16613 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16614
16615 Output log:
16616 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16617
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016618json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16619 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16620 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16621 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16622 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16623
16624 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16625 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16626
16627 Example:
16628 # get a integer value from the request body
16629 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16630 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16631
16632 # get a key with '.' in the name
16633 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16634 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16635
16636 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16637 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16638
16639 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16640 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16641
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016642jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16643 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16644 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16645 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16646 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16647 json_path and output_type parameters.
16648
16649 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16650 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16651
16652jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16653 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16654 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16655 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16656 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16657 json_path and output_type parameters.
16658
16659 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16660 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16661
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016662jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16663 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16664 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016665 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016666 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16667 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16668 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16669 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016670
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016671 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16672 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16673 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16674 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016675
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016676 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16677 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16678 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16679 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16680 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16681 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016682 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016683 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16684
16685 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16686 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16687 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16688 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16689 contents.
16690
16691 The possible return values are the following :
16692
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016693 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16694 | ID | message |
16695 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016696 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016697 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016698 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16699 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16700 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
16701 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
16702 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016703 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016704
16705 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16706 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16707
16708 Example:
16709 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16710 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16711 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16712 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16713 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16714 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16715
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016716language(<value>[,<default>])
16717 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16718 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16719 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16720 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16721 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16722 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16723 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16724 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16725 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016726 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016727 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16728 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016729
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016730 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016732 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16733 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016734
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016735 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16736 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16737 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16738 use_backend spanish if es
16739 use_backend french if fr
16740 use_backend english if en
16741 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016742
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016743length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016744 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16745 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16746 type. The result is of type integer.
16747
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016748lower
16749 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16750 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16751 type. The result is of type string.
16752
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016753ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16754 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16755 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16756 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16757 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16758 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16759 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16760
16761 Example :
16762
16763 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016764 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016765 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16766
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016767ltrim(<chars>)
16768 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16769 representation of the input sample.
16770
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016771map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16772map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16773map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16774 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16775 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16776 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16777 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16778 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16779 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16780 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16781 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016782
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016783 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16784 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16785 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016786
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016787 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016788 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016790 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16791 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16792 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16793 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016794 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16795 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016796 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16797 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16798 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16799 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16800 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16801 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16802 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16803 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016804 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16805 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16806 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016807 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16808 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16809 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16810 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16811 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016812
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016813 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16814 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16815 the corresponding match text.
16816
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016817 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16818 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16819 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16820 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16821 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016822
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016823 Example :
16824
16825 # this is a comment and is ignored
16826 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16827 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16828 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16829 | | | `---------- value
16830 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16831 | `---------------------------- key
16832 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016834mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016835 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16836 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016837 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016838 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016839 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016840 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16841 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16842 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16843 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016844 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016845 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016846
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016847mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016848 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16849 <packettype>.
16850 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16851 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16852 from.
16853 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16854 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16855 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16856
16857 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16858 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16859 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16860 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16861
16862 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16863 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16864 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16865 packets only):
16866 17: Session Expiry Interval
16867 33: Receive Maximum
16868 39: Maximum Packet Size
16869 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16870 25: Request Response Information
16871 23: Request Problem Information
16872 21: Authentication Method
16873 22: Authentication Data
16874 18: Will Delay Interval
16875 1: Payload Format Indicator
16876 2: Message Expiry Interval
16877 3: Content Type
16878 8: Response Topic
16879 9: Correlation Data
16880 Not supported yet:
16881 38: User Property
16882
16883 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16884 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16885 packets only):
16886 17: Session Expiry Interval
16887 33: Receive Maximum
16888 36: Maximum QoS
16889 37: Retain Available
16890 39: Maximum Packet Size
16891 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16892 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16893 31: Reason String
16894 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16895 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16896 42: Shared Subscription Available
16897 19: Server Keep Alive
16898 26: Response Information
16899 28: Server Reference
16900 21: Authentication Method
16901 22: Authentication Data
16902 Not supported yet:
16903 38: User Property
16904
16905 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16906 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16907 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16908 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16909
16910 Example:
16911
16912 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16913 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16914 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16915 if data_in_buffer
16916 # do the same as above
16917 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16918 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16919 if data_in_buffer
16920
16921mqtt_is_valid
16922 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16923
16924 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16925 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16926 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16927 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16928
16929 Example:
16930
16931 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016932 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016933
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016934mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016935 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016936 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16937 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016938 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016939 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016940 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016941 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16942 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16943 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16944 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016945 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016946 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016947
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016948nbsrv
16949 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16950 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16951 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16952 map lookup.
16953
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016954neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016955 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16956 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16957 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16958 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016959
16960not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016961 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016962 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016963 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016964 absence of a flag).
16965
16966odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016967 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016968 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16969
16970or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016971 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016972 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016973 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16974 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016975 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016976 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16977 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16978 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16979 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016980 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016981 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016982
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016983protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16984 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16985 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16986 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16987 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16988 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16989 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16990 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16991 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16992 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16993 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16994 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16995
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016996regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016997 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16998 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16999 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17000 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17001 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17002 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17003 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17004 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17005 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017006 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17007 of characters with other ones.
17008
17009 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17010 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17011 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17012 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17013 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17014 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017015
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017016 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017017
17018 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17019 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17020 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017021 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017022
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017023 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17024 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17025
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017026 # capture groups and backreferences
17027 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017028 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017029 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17030
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017031capture-req(<id>)
17032 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17033 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17034
17035 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017036 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17037 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017038
17039capture-res(<id>)
17040 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17041 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17042
17043 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017044 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17045 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017046
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017047rtrim(<chars>)
17048 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17049 of the input sample.
17050
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017051sdbm([<avalanche>])
17052 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17053 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17054 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17055 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17056 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17057 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17058 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017059 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17060 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017061
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017062secure_memcmp(<var>)
17063 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17064 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17065 match.
17066
17067 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17068 performed in constant time.
17069
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017070 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017071 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17072
17073 Example :
17074
17075 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17076 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17077 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17078 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17079
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017080set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017081 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017082 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17083 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17084 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17085 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017086 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017087 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17088 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017089 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017090 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17091 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017092 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017093 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017094
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017095 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17096 possible conditions :
17097 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17098 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17099 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17100 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17101 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17102 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17103 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17104 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17105 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17106 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17107 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17108 called on the variable.
17109 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17110 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17111 configuration parsing.
17112 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17113 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17114 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17115 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17116 true by default.
17117
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017118sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017119 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017120 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17121
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017122sha2([<bits>])
17123 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17124 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17125
17126 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17127 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017129 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017130 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17131
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017132srv_queue
17133 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17134 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17135 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17136 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17137 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17138
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017139strcmp(<var>)
17140 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17141 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17142 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17143 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17144 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17145 shorter).
17146
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017147 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17148 strings in constant time.
17149
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017150 Example :
17151
17152 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17153 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17154 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17155
17156
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017157sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017158 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17159 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017160 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017161 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17162 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017163 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017164 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17165 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017166 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017167 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17168 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017169 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017170 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017171
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017172table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17173 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17174 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17175 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17176 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17177 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17178 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17179
17180
17181table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17182 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17183 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17184 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17185 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17186 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17187 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17188
17189table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17190 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17191 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017192 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017193 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17194 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17195
17196table_conn_cur(<table>)
17197 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17198 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17199 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17200 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17201 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17202
17203table_conn_rate(<table>)
17204 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17205 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17206 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17207 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17208 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17209
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017210table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17211 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17212 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17213 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17214 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17215 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17216 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17217 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17218 data-type).
17219 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17220
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017221table_gpt0(<table>)
17222 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17223 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17224 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17225 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17226 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17227
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017228table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17229 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17230 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17231 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17232 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17233 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17234 between 0 and 99.
17235 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17236 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17237 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17238 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17239
17240table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17241 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17242 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17243 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17244 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17245 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17246 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17247 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17248 value 0.
17249 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17250 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17251 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17252
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017253table_gpc0(<table>)
17254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17257 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17258 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17259
17260table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17261 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17262 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17263 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17264 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17265 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17266 sample fetch keyword.
17267
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017268table_gpc1(<table>)
17269 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17270 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17271 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17272 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17273 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17274
17275table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17276 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17277 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17278 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17279 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17280 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17281 sample fetch keyword.
17282
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017283table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17284 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17285 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017286 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017287 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17288 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17289
17290table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17291 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17292 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17293 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17294 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17295 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17296 keyword.
17297
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017298table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17301 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17302 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17303 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17304
17305table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17308 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17309 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17310 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17311 keyword.
17312
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017313table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17314 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17315 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017316 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017317 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17318 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17319
17320table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17323 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17324 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17325 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17326 keyword.
17327
17328table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017331 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017332 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17333 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17334 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17335 keyword.
17336
17337table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17338 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17339 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017340 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017341 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17342 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17343 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17344 keyword.
17345
17346table_server_id(<table>)
17347 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17348 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17349 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17350 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17351 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17352 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17353
17354table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17355 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17356 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017357 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017358 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17359 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17360 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17361 keyword.
17362
17363table_sess_rate(<table>)
17364 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17365 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17366 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17367 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17368 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17369 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17370 keyword.
17371
17372table_trackers(<table>)
17373 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17374 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17375 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17376 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17377 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17378 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17379 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17380 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17381 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17382 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17383
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017384ub64dec
17385 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17386 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17387 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17388
17389 Example:
17390 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17391 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17392
17393ub64enc
17394 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17395
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017396upper
17397 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17398 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17399 type. The result is of type string.
17400
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017401url_dec([<in_form>])
17402 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17403 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17404 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17405 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17406 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17407 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017408
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017409url_enc([<enc_type>])
17410 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17411 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17412 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17413 optional argument is here for future changes.
17414
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017415ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017416 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017417 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17418 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17419 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017420 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17421 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17422 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17423 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017424 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017425 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17426 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017427
17428 Example:
17429 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17430 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17431
17432 message Point {
17433 int32 latitude = 1;
17434 int32 longitude = 2;
17435 }
17436
17437 message PPoint {
17438 Point point = 59;
17439 }
17440
17441 message Rectangle {
17442 // One corner of the rectangle.
17443 PPoint lo = 48;
17444 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17445 PPoint hi = 49;
17446 }
17447
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017448 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17449 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17450 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017451
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017452 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17453 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017454 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017455 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17456
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017457 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017458
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017459 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017460
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017461 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17462 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17463 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017464
17465 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17466 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17467 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17468
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017469 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17470 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17471 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017472
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017473
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017474unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017475 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17476 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17477 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17478 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17479 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17480 response),
17481 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17482 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17483 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17484 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17485
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017486utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17487 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17488 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17489 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17490 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17491 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17492 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17493
17494 Example :
17495
17496 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017497 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017498 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17499
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017500word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17501 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17502 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17503 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017504 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017505 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17506 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17507
17508 Example :
17509 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17510 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17511 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17512 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17513 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017514 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017515
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017516wt6([<avalanche>])
17517 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17518 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17519 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17520 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17521 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17522 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17523 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017524 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17525 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017526
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017527xor(<value>)
17528 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017529 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017530 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017531 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017532 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017533 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17534 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017535 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017536 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17537 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017538 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017539 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017540
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017541xxh3([<seed>])
17542 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17543 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17544 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17545 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17546 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17547 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17548 considered as cryptographically secure.
17549
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017550xxh32([<seed>])
17551 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17552 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17553 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17554 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17555 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17556 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17557 as cryptographically secure.
17558
17559xxh64([<seed>])
17560 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17561 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17562 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17563 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17564 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17565 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17566 as cryptographically secure.
17567
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017568
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175697.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570--------------------------------------------
17571
17572A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17573not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17574"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17575The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17576
17577always_false : boolean
17578 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17579 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17580
17581always_true : boolean
17582 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17583 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17584
17585avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017586 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017587 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17588 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17589 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17590 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17591 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17592 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17593 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17594 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17595 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17596 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17597 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17598 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17599 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017602 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17603 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17604 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17605 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017606 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17607
17608be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17609 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17610 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17611 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17612 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17613 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017614 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17615 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017616
17617 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17618 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17619 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17623 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17624 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017625 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017626 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17627 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017628
17629 Example :
17630 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17631 backend dynamic
17632 mode http
17633 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17634 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017635
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017636bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017637 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17638 of the string.
17639
17640bool(<bool>) : bool
17641 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17642 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017646 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17648 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017649
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017650 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017651 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017652 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17653
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017654 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17655 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017656
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017657 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017658 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017660 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017661 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017663 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017664
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017665 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17666 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017668 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017669
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017670cpu_calls : integer
17671 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17672 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17673 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17674 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17675 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17676 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17677
17678cpu_ns_avg : integer
17679 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17680 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17681 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17682 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17683 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17684 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17685 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17686 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17687 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17688 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17689 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17690
17691cpu_ns_tot : integer
17692 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17693 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17694 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17695 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17696 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17697 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17698 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17699 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17700 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17701 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17702 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17703 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17704 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17705
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017706date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017707 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017708
17709 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17710 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17711 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017712 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17713
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017714 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17715 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17716 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17717 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17718 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17719
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017720 Example :
17721
17722 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17723 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017724
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017725 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17726 # millisecond granularity
17727 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17728
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017729date_us : integer
17730 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17731 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17732 from the same timeval structure.
17733
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017734distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17735 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17736 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17737 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17738 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017739 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017740 list of supported tokens.
17741
17742distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17743 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17744 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17745 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17746 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017747 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017748 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17749 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17750 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17751 supported tokens.
17752
17753 Example :
17754 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17755 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17756 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17757 # send large files to the big farm
17758 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17759
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017760env(<name>) : string
17761 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17762 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17763 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17764 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17765 certain way.
17766
17767 Examples :
17768 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17769 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17770
17771 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17772 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017774fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17775 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017776 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17777 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017778 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17779 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017780 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17782 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017783
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017784fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17785 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17786 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17787 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017789fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17790 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17791 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17792 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17793 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17794 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17795 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17796 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17797 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017798
17799 Example :
17800 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17801 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17802 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17803 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17804 frontend mail
17805 bind :25
17806 mode tcp
17807 maxconn 100
17808 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17809 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17810 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17811 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017812
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017813hostname : string
17814 Returns the system hostname.
17815
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017816int(<integer>) : signed integer
17817 Returns a signed integer.
17818
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017819ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17820 Returns an ipv4.
17821
17822ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17823 Returns an ipv6.
17824
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017825lat_ns_avg : integer
17826 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17827 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17828 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17829 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17830 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17831 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17832 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17833 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17834 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017835 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17836 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17837 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17838 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17839 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17840 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017841
17842lat_ns_tot : integer
17843 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17844 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17845 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17846 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17847 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17848 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17849 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17850 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17851 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017852 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17853 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17854 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17855 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17856 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017857 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17858 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17859 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17860 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17861 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17862 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17863
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017864meth(<method>) : method
17865 Returns a method.
17866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17869 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17870 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017871 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17872 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17873 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017874
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017875prio_class : integer
17876 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17877 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17878 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17879
17880prio_offset : integer
17881 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17882 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17883 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17884 set-priority-offset".
17885
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017886proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017887 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17888 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017890queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017891 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17892 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17893 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017894 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17895 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17896 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17897 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17898 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17899
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017900rand([<range>]) : integer
17901 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17902 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17903 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17904 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17905 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017907srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17908 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17909 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17910 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17911 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17912 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017913 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17914 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17915
17916srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17917 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17918 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17919 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17920 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17921 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17922 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17923 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17924
17925 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17926 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927
17928srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17929 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17930 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17931 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017932 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017933 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17934 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17935 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17936
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017937srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17939 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17940 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17941 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17942 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17943 fetch methods.
17944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017945srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17946 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17947 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017948 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17950 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017951 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952 overloading servers).
17953
17954 Example :
17955 # Redirect to a separate back
17956 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17957 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17958 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17959
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017960srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017961 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17962 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17963 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17964
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017965srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017966 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17967 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17968 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17969
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017970srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017971 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17972 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17973 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17974
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017975stopping : boolean
17976 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17977 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17978 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17979
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017980str(<string>) : string
17981 Returns a string.
17982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17984 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17985 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17986
17987table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17988 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17989 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17990 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17991
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017992thread : integer
17993 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17994 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17995 and debugging purposes.
17996
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017997uuid([<version>]) : string
17998 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17999 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18000 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18001
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018002var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018003 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018004 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18005 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18006 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18009 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018010 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18012 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018013 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018014 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180167.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017----------------------------------
18018
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018019The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18021methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18022sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18023TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018024the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18025counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018026"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18027used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18028can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18029Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18030table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18031tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18032currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018034bc_dst : ip
18035 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18036 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18037 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18038 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18039
18040bc_dst_port : integer
18041 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018042 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018043
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018044bc_err : integer
18045 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18046 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18047 and their corresponding error message.
18048
18049bc_err_str : string
18050 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18051 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18052 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18053 corresponding error message.
18054
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018055bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018056 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18057 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18058 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18059
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018060bc_src : ip
18061 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018062 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018063 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18064 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18065
18066bc_src_port : integer
18067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018068 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070be_id : integer
18071 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018072 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18073 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018075be_name : string
18076 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018077 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18078 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018079
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018080be_server_timeout : integer
18081 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18082 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18083 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18084
18085be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18086 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18087 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18088 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18089
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018090cur_server_timeout : integer
18091 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18092 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18093 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18094
18095cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18096 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18097 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18098 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018101 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18102 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18103 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18104 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18105 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18106 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18107 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18108 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18109 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18110 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18111 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112
18113dst_conn : integer
18114 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18115 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18116 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18117 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18118 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18119 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18120 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18121 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018122
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018123dst_is_local : boolean
18124 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18125 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18126 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18127 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018128 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018129 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18130 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18131 it only once per connection.
18132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133dst_port : integer
18134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18135 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018136 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18137 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18138 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18139 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018140
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018141fc_dst : ip
18142 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18143 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18144 for details.
18145
18146fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18147 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18148 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18149 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18150
18151fc_dst_port : integer
18152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18153 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18154 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18155
18156fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018157 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18158 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18159 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018160 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018161 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18162
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018163fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018164 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018165 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018166 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018167 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18168
18169 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18170 | ID | message |
18171 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18172 | 0 | "Success" |
18173 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18174 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18175 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18176 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18177 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18178 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18179 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18180 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18181 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18182 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18183 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18184 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18185 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18186 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18187 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18188 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18189 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18190 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18191 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18192 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18193 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18194 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18195 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18196 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18197 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18198 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18199 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18200 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18201 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18202 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18203 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18204 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18205 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18206 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18207 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18208 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18209 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18210 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18211 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18212 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18213 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18214 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018215 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018216 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18217
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018218fc_fackets : integer
18219 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18220 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18221 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18222 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18223
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018224fc_http_major : integer
18225 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18226 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18227 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18228
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018229fc_lost : integer
18230 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18231 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18232 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18233 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18234
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018235fc_pp_authority : string
18236 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18237 if any.
18238
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018239fc_pp_unique_id : string
18240 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18241 if any.
18242
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018243fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18244 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18245 header.
18246
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018247fc_reordering : integer
18248 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18249 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18250 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18251 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18252
18253fc_retrans : integer
18254 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18255 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18256 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18257 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18258
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018259fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18260 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18261 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18262 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18263 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18264 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18265 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18266
18267fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18268 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18269 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18270 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18271 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18272 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18273 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18274
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018275fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018276 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18277 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18278 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18279 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18280
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018281fc_src : ip
18282 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18283 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18284 for details.
18285
18286fc_src_is_local : boolean
18287 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18288 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18289 "src_is_local" for details.
18290
18291fc_src_port : integer
18292
18293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18294 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18295 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18296
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018297
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018298fc_unacked : integer
18299 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18300 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18301 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18302 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018303
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018304fe_defbe : string
18305 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18306 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018308fe_id : integer
18309 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018310 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018311 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18312
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018313fe_name : string
18314 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18315 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18316 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18317
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018318fe_client_timeout : integer
18319 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18320 current frontend.
18321
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018322sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018323sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18324sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18325sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018326 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18327 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18328 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18329
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018330sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018331sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18332sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18333sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018334 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18335 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18336 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18337
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018338sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18339 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18340 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18341 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18342 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18343 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18344 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18345 will always return zero.
18346 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18347 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18348
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018349sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018350sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18351sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18352sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018353 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18354 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018355 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18356 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18357 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018358
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018359 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018360 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18361 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018362 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18363 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18364 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018365 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18366 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18367
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018368sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18369sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18370sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18371sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18372 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18373 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18374 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18375 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18376 when a first ACL was verified.
18377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018378sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018379sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18380sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18381sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018382 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018383 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018385sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018386sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18387sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18388sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018389 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18390 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18391 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18392
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018393sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018394sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18395sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18396sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018397 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18398 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18399 See also src_conn_rate.
18400
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018401sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18402 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18403 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18404 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18405 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18406 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18407 index, zero is returned.
18408 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18409 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18410
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018411sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018412sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18413sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18414sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018415 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018416 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018417
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018418sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18419sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18420sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18421sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18422 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18423 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18424
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018425sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18426 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18427 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18428 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18429 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18430 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18431 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18432 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18433
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018434sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18435sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18436sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18437sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18438 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18439 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18440
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018441sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18442 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18443 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18444 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18445 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18446 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18447 between 0 and 2.
18448 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18449 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18450 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18451 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18452 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18453
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018454sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018455sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18456sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18457sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018458 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18459 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18460 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018461 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18462 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18463 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018464
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018465sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18466sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18467sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18468sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18469 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18470 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18471 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18472 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18473 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18474 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18475
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018476sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018477sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18478sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18479sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018480 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018481 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18482 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018484sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018485sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18486sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18487sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018488 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18489 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18490 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18491 src_http_err_rate.
18492
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018493sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18494sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18495sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18496sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18497 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18498 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18499 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18500
18501sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18502sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18503sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18504sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18505 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18506 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18507 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18508 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18509
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018510sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018511sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18512sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18513sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018514 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018515 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18516 src_http_req_cnt.
18517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018518sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018519sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18520sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18521sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018522 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18523 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18524 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18525 src_http_req_rate.
18526
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018527sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18528 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18529 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18530 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18531 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18532 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18533 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18534 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18535 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18536 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018538sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018539sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18540sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18541sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018542 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018543 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18544 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18545 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18546 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018547
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018548 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018549 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18550 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018551 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18552
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018553sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18554sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18555sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18556sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18557 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18558 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18559 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18560 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18561 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18562
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018563sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018564sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18565sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18566sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018567 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18568 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18569 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018570
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018571sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018572sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18573sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18574sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018575 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18576 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18577 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018578
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018579sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018580sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18581sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18582sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018583 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018584 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18585 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18586 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018587 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018588 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018590sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018591sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18592sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18593sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018594 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18595 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18596 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18597 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18598 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018599 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018600
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018601sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018602sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18603sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18604sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018605 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18606 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18607 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018609sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018610sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18611sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18612sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018613 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18614 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018615 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018616 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18617 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18619 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18620 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018622so_id : integer
18623 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18624 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18625 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018626
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018627so_name : string
18628 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18629 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18630 strings instead of integers.
18631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018633 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18634 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18635 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18636 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18637 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18638 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18639 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18640 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18641 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18642 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18643 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18644 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18645 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18646 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18647 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018648
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018649 Example:
18650 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18651 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18654 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18655 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18656 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018657 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018659src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18660 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18661 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018662 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018663 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018664
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018665src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18666 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18667 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18668 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18669 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18670 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18671 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18672 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18673 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18676 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18677 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18678 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18679 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18680 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18681 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018682
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018683 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018684 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18685 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18686 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18687 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018688 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018689 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18690 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18691
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018692src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18693 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18694 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18695 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18696 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18697 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18698 was verified.
18699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018701 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018703 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018704 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018706src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018707 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018708 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18709 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018710 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018712src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18713 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18714 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18715 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018716 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018717
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018718src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18719 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18720 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18721 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18722 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18723 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18724 is returned.
18725 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18726 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18727 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018730 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018731 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018732 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018733 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018734
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018735src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18736 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18737 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18738 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18739 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18740
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018741src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18742 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18743 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18744 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18745 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18746 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18747 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18748
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018749src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18750 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18751 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18752 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18753 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18754
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018755src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18756 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18757 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18758 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18759 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18760 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18761 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18762 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18763 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18764 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18765 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018767src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018768 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018769 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018770 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18771 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018772 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18773 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18774 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018775
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018776src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18777 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18778 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18779 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18780 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18781 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18782 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18783 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018785src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018786 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018788 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018789 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018790 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018792src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18793 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18794 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18795 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18796 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018797 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018798
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018799src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18800 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18801 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018802 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018803 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18804 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18805
18806src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18807 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18808 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18809 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18810 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18811 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18812 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018815 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018816 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18817 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018818 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018820src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18821 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18822 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18823 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018824 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018825 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018826
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018827src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18828 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18829 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18830 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18831 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18832 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18833 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18834 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18835 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18838 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18839 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18840 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018841 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018842 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18843 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018844
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018845 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018846 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018847 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018848 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018849
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018850src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18851 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18852 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18853 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18854 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18855 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18856 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18857
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018858src_is_local : boolean
18859 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18860 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18861 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18862 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018863 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018864 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18865 once per connection.
18866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018868 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18869 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18870 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18871 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18872 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018874src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018875 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18876 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18877 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18878 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18879 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881src_port : integer
18882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018883 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
18884 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
18885 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
18886 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018888src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018889 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018890 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18891 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18892 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018893 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018895src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18896 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18897 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18898 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18899 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018900 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018902src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18903 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18904 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18905 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18906 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18907 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18908 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18909 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18910 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018911
18912 Example :
18913 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18914 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18915 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18916 listen ssh
18917 bind :22
18918 mode tcp
18919 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018920 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018921 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018922 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018924srv_id : integer
18925 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18926 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018927 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018928
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018929srv_name : string
18930 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18931 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018932 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018933
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189347.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018935----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018936
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018937The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18939when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18940usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018941future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018942
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001894351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18944 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18945 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18946 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18947 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18948 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18949
18950 Example :
18951 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18952 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18953 # the request.
18954 frontend http-in
18955 bind *:8081
18956 default_backend servers
18957 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18958 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18959
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018960ssl_bc : boolean
18961 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18962 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018963 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18964 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018965
18966ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18967 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018968 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18969 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018970
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018971ssl_bc_alpn : string
18972 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18973 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018974 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018975 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18976 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18977 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18978 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18979 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018980 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18981 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018982
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018983ssl_bc_cipher : string
18984 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018985 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18986 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018987
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018988ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18989 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18990 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18991 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018992 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018993
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018994ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018995 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018996 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
18997 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
18998 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
18999 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019000 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19001 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19002 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19003
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019004ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019005 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019006 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19007 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19008 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019009
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019010ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19011 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19012 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019013 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19014 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019015
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019016ssl_bc_npn : string
19017 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19018 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019019 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019020 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19021 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19022 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19023 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019024 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19025 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019026
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019027ssl_bc_protocol : string
19028 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019029 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19030 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019031
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019032ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019033 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019034 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019035 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19036 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019037
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019038ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19039 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19040 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19041 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019042 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019043
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019044ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19045 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19046 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019047 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19048 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019049
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019050ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19051 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19052 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19053 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019054 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019055
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019056ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19057 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019058 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19059 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19062 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19063 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19064 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19065 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19066 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019068ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19069 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19070 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19071 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19072 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019073
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019074ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019075 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19076 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19077 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019078 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019079 does not support resumed sessions.
19080
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019081ssl_c_der : binary
19082 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19083 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19084 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086ssl_c_err : integer
19087 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19088 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19089 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19090 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19091 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019092
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019093ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19095 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19096 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19097 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19098 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19099 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19100 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19101 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019102 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19103 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19104 LDAP v3.
19105 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19106 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019108ssl_c_key_alg : string
19109 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19110 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19111 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019113ssl_c_notafter : string
19114 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19115 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19116 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118ssl_c_notbefore : string
19119 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19120 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19121 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019122
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019123ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19125 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19126 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19127 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19128 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19129 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19130 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19131 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019132 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19133 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19134 LDAP v3.
19135 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19136 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019138ssl_c_serial : binary
19139 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19140 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19141 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19144 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19145 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19146 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019147 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19148 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19149
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019150 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019151 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019153ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19154 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19155 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19156 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019158ssl_c_used : boolean
19159 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19160 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019162ssl_c_verify : integer
19163 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19164 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19165 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19166 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019168ssl_c_version : integer
19169 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19170 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019171
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019172ssl_f_der : binary
19173 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19174 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19175 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19176
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019177ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019178 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19179 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19180 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19181 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019182 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19184 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19185 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019186 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19187 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19188 LDAP v3.
19189 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19190 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192ssl_f_key_alg : string
19193 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19194 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19195 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197ssl_f_notafter : string
19198 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19199 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19200 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202ssl_f_notbefore : string
19203 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19204 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19205 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019206
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019207ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019208 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19209 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19210 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19211 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19212 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19213 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19214 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19215 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019216 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19217 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19218 LDAP v3.
19219 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19220 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222ssl_f_serial : binary
19223 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19224 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19225 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019226
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019227ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19228 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19229 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19230 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19233 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19234 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19235 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019237ssl_f_version : integer
19238 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19239 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19240
19241ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019242 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19243 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19244 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019246 Example :
19247 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19248 listen http-https
19249 bind :80
19250 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19251 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19252
19253ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19254 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19255 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19256
19257ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019258 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019260 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19262 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19263 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19264 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19265 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19266 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268ssl_fc_cipher : string
19269 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19270 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019271
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019272ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19273 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19274 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019275 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019276 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19277 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19278 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019279
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019280 Example:
19281 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19282 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19283 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19284 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19285 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19286 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19287 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19288 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19289 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19290
19291ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019292 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019293 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019294 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19295 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019296 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19297 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019298
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019299ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019300 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019301 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019302 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019303 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19304 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19305 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19306 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19307 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19308 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019309
19310ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019311 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019312 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19313 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019314
19315ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19316 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19317 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019318 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019319
19320 Example:
19321 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19322 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19323 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19324 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19325 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19326 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19327 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19328 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19329 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19330
19331ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19332 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19333 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019334 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019335 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19336 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19337 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19338
19339 Example:
19340 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19341 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19342 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19343 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19344 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19345 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19346 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19347 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19348 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19349
19350ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19351 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19352 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019353 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019354 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19355 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19356 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19357
19358 Example:
19359 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19360 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19361 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19362 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19363 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19364 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19365 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19366 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19367 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019368
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019369ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19370 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19371 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19372 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19373
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019374ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19375 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19376 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19377 transport layer.
19378 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19379 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19380 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19381 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19382
19383ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19384 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19385 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19386 transport layer.
19387 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19388 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19389 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19390 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19391
19392ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19393 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19394 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19395 transport layer.
19396 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19397 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19398 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19399 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19400
19401ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19402 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19403 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19404 transport layer.
19405 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19406 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19407 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19408 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19409
19410ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19411 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19412 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19413 transport layer.
19414 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19415 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19416 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19417 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19418
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019419ssl_fc_err : integer
19420 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19421 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19422 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19423 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19424 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19425 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19426 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19427 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19428 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19429 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19430 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19431 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19432 codes.
19433
19434ssl_fc_err_str : string
19435 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19436 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19437 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19438 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19439 also "ssl_fc_err".
19440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019442 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19443 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019444 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19445 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19446 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19447 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019448
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019449ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19450 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19451 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19452 wait until the handshake happened.
19453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019454ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19455 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019456 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19457 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019458 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019459 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019460
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019461ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019462 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019463 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19464 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019466ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019467 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019468 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019469 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19470 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19471 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19472 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19473 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19474 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019476ssl_fc_protocol : string
19477 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19478 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019479
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019480ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19481 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19482 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019483 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19484 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019485
19486 Example:
19487 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19488 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19489 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19490 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19491 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19492 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19493 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19494 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19495 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19496
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019497ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019498 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019499 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019500 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019501
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019502ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19503 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19504 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19505 transport layer.
19506 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19507 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19508 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19509 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19510
19511ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19512 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19513 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19514 transport layer.
19515 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19516 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19517 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19518 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19519
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019520ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19521 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19522 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19523 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019525ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19526 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19527 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19528 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19529 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019530
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019531ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19532 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19533 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19534 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19535 BoringSSL.
19536
19537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538ssl_fc_sni : string
19539 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19540 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019541 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19543 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19544
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019545 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019546 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019548 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019549 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19553 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019555ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19556 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19557 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019558
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019559ssl_s_der : binary
19560 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19561 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19562 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19563
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019564ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19565 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19566 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19567 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019568 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019569 does not support resumed sessions.
19570
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019571ssl_s_key_alg : string
19572 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19573 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19574 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19575
19576ssl_s_notafter : string
19577 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19578 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19579 transport layer.
19580
19581ssl_s_notbefore : string
19582 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19583 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19584 transport layer.
19585
19586ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19587 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19588 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19589 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19590 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19591 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19592 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019593 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19594 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019595 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19596 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19597 LDAP v3.
19598 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19599 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19600
19601ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19602 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19603 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19604 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19605 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19606 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19607 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019608 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19609 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019610 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19611 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19612 LDAP v3.
19613 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19614 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19615
19616ssl_s_serial : binary
19617 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19618 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19619 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19620
19621ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19622 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19623 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19624 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19625
19626ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19627 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19628 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19629 layer.
19630
19631ssl_s_version : integer
19632 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19633 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019634
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200196357.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019636------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019638Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19639sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19640only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19641For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19642be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19643can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19644sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19645for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19646content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019647
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019648Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19649 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019650 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019651 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19652 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19653 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19654 sample expression). So be careful.
19655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019656payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019657 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019658 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19659 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19662 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019663 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019666req.len : integer
19667req_len : integer (deprecated)
19668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19669 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19670 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19671 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19672 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019673 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019674 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19675 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019677req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19678 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019679 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19680 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19681 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19682 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019684 ACL alternatives :
19685 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019687req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19688 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19689 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19690 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19691 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019693 ACL alternatives :
19694 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019696 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019698req.proto_http : boolean
19699req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19700 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19701 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19702 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19703 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19704 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19705 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19706 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708 Example:
19709 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19710 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19711 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019712 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019714req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19715rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19716 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19717 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19718 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19719 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19720 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19721 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19722 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019724 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19725 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19726 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19727 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19728 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19729 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019731 ACL derivatives :
19732 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734 Example :
19735 listen tse-farm
19736 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19737 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19738 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19739 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19740 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19741 persist rdp-cookie
19742 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19743 # This is only useful makes sense if
19744 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19745 stick-table type string size 204800
19746 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19747 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19748 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019750 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19751 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019753req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19754rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19755 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19756 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19757 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19758 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019760 ACL derivatives :
19761 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019762
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019763req.ssl_alpn : string
19764 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19765 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19766 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19767 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19768 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19769 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019770 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019771
19772 Examples :
19773 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19774 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19775 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019776 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019777 default_backend bk_default
19778
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019779req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19780 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19781 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019782 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19783 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19784 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19785 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19786 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19789req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19790 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19791 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19792 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19793 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19794 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19795 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19796 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019798req.ssl_sni : string
19799req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19800 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19801 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19802 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19803 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19804 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019805 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19806 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19807 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19808 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19809 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19810 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19811 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19812 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19813 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019815 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019816 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818 Examples :
19819 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19820 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19821 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019822 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019823 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019824
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019825req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19826 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19827 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19828 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19829 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19830 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19831 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19832 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19833 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19834 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019836req.ssl_ver : integer
19837req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19838 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19839 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19840 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19841 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19842 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19843 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19844 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019845 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019848 ACL derivatives :
19849 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019850
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019851res.len : integer
19852 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19853 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19854 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19855 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19856 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019857 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019858 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019859 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019861res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19862 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019863 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019864 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019865 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019866 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019868res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19869 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19870 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19871 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019872 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19873 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019875 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019876
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019877res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19878rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19879 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19880 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19881 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19882 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19883 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19884 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19885 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019887wait_end : boolean
19888 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19889 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019890 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019891 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19892 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019893 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019894 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19895 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019897 Examples :
19898 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19899 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19900 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019902 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19903 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19904 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19905 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19906 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19907 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19908 tcp-request content reject
19909
19910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199117.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019912--------------------------------------
19913
19914It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19915This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19916data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19917its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19918HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19919content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19920to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19921more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19922response are indexed.
19923
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019924Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19925 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19926 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19927 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19928 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19929 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19930 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932base : string
19933 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19934 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19935 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19936 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19937 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19938 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19939 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19940 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19941
19942 ACL derivatives :
19943 base : exact string match
19944 base_beg : prefix match
19945 base_dir : subdir match
19946 base_dom : domain match
19947 base_end : suffix match
19948 base_len : length match
19949 base_reg : regex match
19950 base_sub : substring match
19951
19952base32 : integer
19953 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19954 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19955 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019956 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19957 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19958 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019959
19960base32+src : binary
19961 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19962 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19963 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19964 per-URL counters.
19965
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019966baseq : string
19967 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19968 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19969 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19970 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19971
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019972capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19973 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19974 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19975 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19976
19977capture.req.method : string
19978 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19979 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19980 because it's allocated.
19981
19982capture.req.uri : string
19983 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19984 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19985 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19986 allocated.
19987
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019988capture.req.ver : string
19989 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19990 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19991 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19992
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019993capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19994 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19995 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19996 The first entry is an index of 0.
19997 See also: "capture response header"
19998
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019999capture.res.ver : string
20000 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20001 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20002 persistent flag.
20003
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020004req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020005 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20006 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20007 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020008
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020009req.body_param([<name>) : string
20010 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20011 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20012 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20013 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20014 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20015 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20016 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20017 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20018 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20019 given.
20020
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020021req.body_len : integer
20022 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20023 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020024 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20025 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020026
20027req.body_size : integer
20028 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020029 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20030 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032req.cook([<name>]) : string
20033cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20034 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20035 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20036 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20037 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20038 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20039 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20040 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20041 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20042
20043 ACL derivatives :
20044 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20045 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20046 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20047 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20048 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20049 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20050 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20051 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020053req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20054cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20055 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20056 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20059cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20060 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20061 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20062 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20063 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020065cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20066 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20067 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20068 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20069 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020070 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020071 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20072 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20073 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20074 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020076hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20077 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20078 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20079 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20080 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020081 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020083req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020084 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20085 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20086 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20087 with headers such as User-Agent.
20088
20089 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20090 found.
20091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020092 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20093 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20094 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020095 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020097req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20098 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20099 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020100 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20101 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020103req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020104 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20105 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20106 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20107 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20108 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20109 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20110 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20111
20112 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20113 found.
20114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020115 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20116 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20117 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020118 with -1 being the last one.
20119
20120 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20121 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020123 ACL derivatives :
20124 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20125 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20126 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20127 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20128 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20129 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20130 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20131 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20132
20133req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20134hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20135 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20136 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020137 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20138 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20139 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20140
20141 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20142 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20143 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20144
20145 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020146
20147req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20148hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20149 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20150 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20151 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020152 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20153 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20154 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20155 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20156 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020157
20158 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20159
20160 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020161
20162req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20163hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20164 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20165 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20166 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020167
20168 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20169
20170 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020171
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020172req.hdrs : string
20173 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20174 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20175 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20176 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20177
20178req.hdrs_bin : binary
20179 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20180 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20181 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20182 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20183 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20184 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20185
20186 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020187
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020188 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20189 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020191http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20192 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20193 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20194 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20195 basic auth is supported.
20196
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020197http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20198 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20199 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20200 performed on the data sent by the client.
20201 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20202 Authorization one.
20203
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020204http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20205 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20206 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20207 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20208 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020209 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20210 basic auth is supported.
20211
20212 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020213 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20214 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20215 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20216 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020217
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020218http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020219 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20220 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20221 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020222
20223http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020224 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20225 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20226 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020227
20228http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020229 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20230 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20231 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020233http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020234 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20235 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020236 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20237 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020239method : integer + string
20240 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20241 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20242 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20243 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20244 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20245 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20246 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020248 ACL derivatives :
20249 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020251 Example :
20252 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20253 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20254 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020256path : string
20257 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20258 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20259 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20260 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20261 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020262 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020263 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020265 ACL derivatives :
20266 path : exact string match
20267 path_beg : prefix match
20268 path_dir : subdir match
20269 path_dom : domain match
20270 path_end : suffix match
20271 path_len : length match
20272 path_reg : regex match
20273 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020274
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020275pathq : string
20276 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20277 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20278 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20279 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20280 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20281 result in both cases.
20282
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020283query : string
20284 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20285 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20286 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20287 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020288 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020289 which stops before the question mark.
20290
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020291req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20292 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20293 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20294 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20295 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020297req.ver : string
20298req_ver : string (deprecated)
20299 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20300 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20301 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020303 ACL derivatives :
20304 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020305
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020306res.body : binary
20307 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20308 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020309 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20310
20311 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020312
20313res.body_len : integer
20314 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20315 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020316 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20317
20318 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020319
20320res.body_size : integer
20321 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20322 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20323 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20324 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020325 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20326
20327 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020328
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020329res.cache_hit : boolean
20330 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20331 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20332
20333res.cache_name : string
20334 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20335 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20336 empty string.
20337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020338res.comp : boolean
20339 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20340 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20341 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020343res.comp_algo : string
20344 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20345 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20346 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020348res.cook([<name>]) : string
20349scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20350 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20351 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020352 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20353
20354 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020356 ACL derivatives :
20357 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020359res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20360scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20361 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20362 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020363 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20364
20365 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020367res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20368scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20369 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20370 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020371 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20372
20373 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020375res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020376 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20377 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20378
20379 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20380 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20381
20382 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20383
20384 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020386res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020387 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20388 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20389
20390 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20391 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20392
20393 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020395res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20396shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020397 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20398 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20399
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020400 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020401 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20402
20403 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020405 ACL derivatives :
20406 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20407 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20408 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20409 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20410 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20411 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20412 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20413 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20414
20415res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20416shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020417 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20418 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20419
20420 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020421 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020422
20423 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020425res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20426shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020427 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20428 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20429
20430 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20431
20432 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020433
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020434res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20435 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20436 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20437 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020438 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20439
20440 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020442res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20443shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020444 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20445 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20446
20447 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20448
20449 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020450
20451res.hdrs : string
20452 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20453 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20454 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020455 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20456
20457 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020458
20459res.hdrs_bin : binary
20460 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20461 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20462 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20463 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20464 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20465 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20466 (length of 0 for both).
20467
20468 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20469
20470 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20471 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020473res.ver : string
20474resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20475 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020476 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20477
20478 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020480 ACL derivatives :
20481 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020483set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20484 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20485 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020486 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020487 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020489 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20490 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020492status : integer
20493 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20494 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020495 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20496
20497 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020498
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020499unique-id : string
20500 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20501 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20502 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20503 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20504 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20505 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020507url : string
20508 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20509 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20510 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20511 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20512 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20513 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20514 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020516 ACL derivatives :
20517 url : exact string match
20518 url_beg : prefix match
20519 url_dir : subdir match
20520 url_dom : domain match
20521 url_end : suffix match
20522 url_len : length match
20523 url_reg : regex match
20524 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020526url_ip : ip
20527 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20528 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20529 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20530 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020531 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20532 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020534url_port : integer
20535 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020536 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020537
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020538urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20539url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020540 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20541 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020542 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20543 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20544 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20545 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020546 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20547 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020548 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20549 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020551 ACL derivatives :
20552 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20553 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20554 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20555 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20556 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20557 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20558 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20559 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020560
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020562 Example :
20563 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20564 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20565 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20566 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020567
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020568urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020569 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20570 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20571 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020572
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020573url32 : integer
20574 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20575 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20576 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20577 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20578 is an unsigned integer.
20579
20580url32+src : binary
20581 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20582 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20583 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20584
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020585
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200205867.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020587---------------------------------------
20588
20589This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20590used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20591purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20592There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20593or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20594any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20595for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20596
20597internal.htx.data : integer
20598 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20599 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20600
20601internal.htx.free : integer
20602 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20603 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20604
20605internal.htx.free_data : integer
20606 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20607 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20608
20609internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020610 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20611 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20612 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020613
20614internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20615 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20616 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20617
20618internal.htx.size : integer
20619 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20620 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20621
20622internal.htx.used : integer
20623 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20624 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20625 direction.
20626
20627internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20628 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20629 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20630 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20631 of the special value :
20632 * head : The oldest inserted block
20633 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020634 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020635
20636internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20637 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20638 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20639 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20640 integer or one of the special value :
20641 * head : The oldest inserted block
20642 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020643 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020644
20645internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20646 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20647 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20648 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20649 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20650
20651 * head : The oldest inserted block
20652 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020653 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020654
20655internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20656 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20657 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20658 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20659 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20660
20661 * head : The oldest inserted block
20662 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020663 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020664
20665internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20666 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20667 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20668 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20669 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20670
20671 * head : The oldest inserted block
20672 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020673 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020674
20675internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20676 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20677 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20678 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20679 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20680
20681 * head : The oldest inserted block
20682 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020683 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020684
20685internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20686 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20687 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20688 it returns false.
20689
20690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200206917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020692---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020694Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20695every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020696order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020698ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020699---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20700FALSE always_false never match
20701HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20702HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20703HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020704HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020705HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20706HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20707HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20708HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020020709LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020710METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20711METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20712METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20713METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20714METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20715METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20716METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20717METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20718RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20719REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20720TRUE always_true always match
20721WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20722---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020723
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207258. Logging
20726----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020728One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20729provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20730very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20731provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20732state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020733to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020734headers.
20735
20736In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20737about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20738send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20739
20740 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20741 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20742 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20743 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20744 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020745 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020746 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020747
20748The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20749allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20750as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20751while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20752real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20753delay.
20754
20755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207568.1. Log levels
20757---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020758
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020759TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020760source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020761HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20762in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20763track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20764syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20765about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020766
20767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207688.2. Log formats
20769----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020770
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020771HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020772and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20773slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20774options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020775
20776 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20777 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20778 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20779 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20780 extents.
20781
20782 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20783 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20784 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20785 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20786 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20787
20788 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20789 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20790 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20791 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20792 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20793
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020794 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20795 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20796 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20797 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20798
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020799 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020801Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20802specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20803field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20804servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20805always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20806identifier.
20807
20808Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20809 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20810 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20811 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20812 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20813
20814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208158.2.1. Default log format
20816-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020817
20818This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20819as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20820format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20821
20822 Example :
20823 listen www
20824 mode http
20825 log global
20826 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20827
20828 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20829 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20830 (www/HTTP)
20831
20832 Field Format Extract from the example above
20833 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20834 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20835 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20836 4 'to' to
20837 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20838 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20839
20840Detailed fields description :
20841 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20842 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20843 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20844 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20845 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20846 and processed the connection.
20847 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20848
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020849In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20850"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20851connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20852
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020853It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20854will eventually disappear.
20855
20856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208578.2.2. TCP log format
20858---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020859
20860The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20861is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20862information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20863counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20864emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20865environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20866the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20867sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020868specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010020869not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20870
20871The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
20872exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010020873if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010020874
20875 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
20876 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20877 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
20878
20879A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
20880are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020881
20882 Example :
20883 frontend fnt
20884 mode tcp
20885 option tcplog
20886 log global
20887 default_backend bck
20888
20889 backend bck
20890 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20891
20892 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20893 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20894 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20895
20896 Field Format Extract from the example above
20897 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20898 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20899 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20900 4 frontend_name fnt
20901 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20902 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20903 7 bytes_read* 212
20904 8 termination_state --
20905 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20906 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20907
20908Detailed fields description :
20909 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020910 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020911 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20912 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020913 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020914 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020915 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020916
20917 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020918 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20919 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20920 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020921
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020922 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020923 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20924 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020925 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20926 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20927 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20928 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020929
20930 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20931 and processed the connection.
20932
20933 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20934 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20935 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20936 applications.
20937
20938 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20939 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20940 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20941 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20942 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20943
20944 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20945 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20946 See "Timers" below for more details.
20947
20948 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20949 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20950 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20951 "Timers" below for more details.
20952
20953 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020954 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020955 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20956 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20957 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20958 details.
20959
20960 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20961 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20962 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20963 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20964 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20965
20966 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20967 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20968 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20969 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20970 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20971 for more details.
20972
20973 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020974 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020975 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20976 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20977 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020978 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020979
20980 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20981 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20982 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20983 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20984 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20985 caused by a denial of service attack.
20986
20987 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20988 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20989 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20990 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20991 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20992 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20993 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20994 denial of service attack.
20995
20996 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20997 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20998 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20999 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21000 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21001 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21002 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21003 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21004 be processed than on other servers.
21005
21006 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21007 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21008 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21009 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021010 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021011 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21012 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21013 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21014 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21015 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21016 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21017 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21018 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21019
21020 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21021 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21022 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21023 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21024 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21025 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021026 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021027 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21028
21029 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21030 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21031 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21032 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21033 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21034 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021035 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21037 occurs.
21038
21039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210408.2.3. HTTP log format
21041----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021042
21043The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21044is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21045the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21046are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21047emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21048generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21049"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21050which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021051frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21052is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021053
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021054The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21055exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021056if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021057
21058 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21059 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21060 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21061
21062And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21063this exact string:
21064
21065 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21066 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21067 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21068 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21069
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21071slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21072with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21073
21074 Example :
21075 frontend http-in
21076 mode http
21077 option httplog
21078 log global
21079 default_backend bck
21080
21081 backend static
21082 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21083
21084 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21085 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21086 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021087 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021088
21089 Field Format Extract from the example above
21090 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21091 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021092 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021093 4 frontend_name http-in
21094 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021095 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021096 7 status_code 200
21097 8 bytes_read* 2750
21098 9 captured_request_cookie -
21099 10 captured_response_cookie -
21100 11 termination_state ----
21101 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21102 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21103 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21104 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21105 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021106
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021107Detailed fields description :
21108 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021109 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021110 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21111 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021112 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021113 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021114 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021115
21116 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021117 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21118 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21119 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021121 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021122 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021123
21124 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21125 and processed the connection.
21126
21127 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21128 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21129 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21130
21131 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21132 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21133 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21134 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21135 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21136 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21137
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021138 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21139 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21140 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021141 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021142 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21143 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021144 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021145 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021146
21147 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21148 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021149 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150
21151 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21152 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021153 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21154 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155
21156 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21157 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21158 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21159 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21160 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021161 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21162 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021163
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021164 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021165 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21166 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21167 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21168 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21169 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21170 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021171 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021172
21173 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021174 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21175 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021176
21177 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21178 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021179 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021180 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21181 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21182 overflowing.
21183
21184 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21185 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21186 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21187 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21188 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21189 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21190 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21191 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21192
21193 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21194 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21195 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21196 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21197 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21198 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21199 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21200 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21201
21202 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21203 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21204 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21205 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21206 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21207 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21208 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21209
21210 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021211 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021212 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21213 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21214 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021215 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021216 system.
21217
21218 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21219 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21220 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21221 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21222 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21223 caused by a denial of service attack.
21224
21225 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21226 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21227 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21228 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21229 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21230 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21231 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21232 denial of service attack.
21233
21234 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21235 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21236 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21237 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21238 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21239 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21240 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21241 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21242 processed than on other servers.
21243
21244 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21245 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21246 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21247 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021248 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021249 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21250 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21251 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21252 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21253 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21254 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21255 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21256 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21257
21258 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21259 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21260 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21261 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21262 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21263 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021264 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021265 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21266
21267 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21268 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21269 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21270 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21271 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21272 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021273 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021274 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21275 occurs.
21276
21277 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21278 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21279 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21280 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21281 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21282 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21283 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21284 cookies" below for more details.
21285
21286 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21287 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21288 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21289 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21290 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21291 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21292 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21293 and cookies" below for more details.
21294
21295 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21296 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21297 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21298 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21299 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21300 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21301 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21302 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21303
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021304
213058.2.4. HTTPS log format
21306----------------------
21307
21308The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21309extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21310information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21311frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21312end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21313matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21314sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21315dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21316"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21317
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021318The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21319exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021320if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021321
21322 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21323 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21324 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21325 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021326 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021327
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021328This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21329appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21330HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021331
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021332 Example :
21333 frontend https-in
21334 mode http
21335 option httpslog
21336 log global
21337 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21338 default_backend bck
21339
21340 backend static
21341 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21342
21343 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21344 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21345 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021346 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21347 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021348
21349 Field Format Extract from the example above
21350 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21351 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21352 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21353 4 frontend_name https-in
21354 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21355 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21356 7 status_code 200
21357 8 bytes_read* 2750
21358 9 captured_request_cookie -
21359 10 captured_response_cookie -
21360 11 termination_state ----
21361 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21362 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21363 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21364 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21365 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021366 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021367 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021368 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21369 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021370
21371Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021372 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21373 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21374 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021375
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021376 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21377 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21378 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021379 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021380 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021381
21382 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21383 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21384 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21385 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21386
21387 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21388 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21389 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21390 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21391
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021392 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21393 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21394 can be shared by multiple requests.
21395
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021396 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21397 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21398 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21399 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21400 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21401
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021402 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21403
21404 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21405
21406
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100214078.2.5. Error log format
21408-----------------------
21409
21410When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21411protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21412unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21413line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21414"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21415will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21416logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21417
21418The default format looks like this :
21419
21420 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21421 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21422 Connection error during SSL handshake
21423
21424 Field Format Extract from the example above
21425 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21426 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21427 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21428 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21429 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21430
21431These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21432failures.
21433
21434By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21435above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21436defined format.
21437
21438An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21439source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21440number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21441internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21442error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21443the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21444certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21445indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21446indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21447ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21448are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21449would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21450regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21451
21452 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021453 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021454 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21455 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21456
21457
214588.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021459------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021460
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021461When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21462ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21463a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21464formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21465looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21466and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021467
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021468HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021469Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21470separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21471prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21472
21473Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21474variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021475("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021476
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021477If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021478as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021479less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21480the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21481
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021482Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21483"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21484delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21485preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021486
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021487Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21488'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21489https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21490such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21491
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021492Flags are :
21493 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021494 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021495 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21496 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021497
21498 Example:
21499
21500 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21501 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21502
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021503 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21504
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021505Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21506
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021507 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021508 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021509 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21510 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21511 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021512 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21513 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21514 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021515 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021516 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021517 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021518 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021519 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021520 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21521 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021522 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021523 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021524 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021525 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021526 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021527 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021528 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021529 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21530 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21531 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21532 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21533 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021534 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021535 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021536 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021537 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021538 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021539 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21540 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021541 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21542 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21543 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021544 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021545 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21546 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021547 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021548 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21549 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21550 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021551 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021552 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021553 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21554 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21555 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21556 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021557 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021558 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021559 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021560 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021561 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021562 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021563 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21564 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21565 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021566 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021567 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21568 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021569 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021570 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21571 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021572 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021573 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021574 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021575 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021576
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021577 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021578
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215808.3. Advanced logging options
21581-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021582
21583Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21584just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21585options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21586for more information about their usage.
21587
21588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21590------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021591
21592It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021593HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021594commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21595monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21596ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21597
21598 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21599 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21600 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21601 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21602
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021603 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21604 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021605
21606 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21607 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21608 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21609
21610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216118.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21612----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021613
21614The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21615what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21616or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021617"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021618just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21619log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21620after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21621is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21622with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21623with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21624
21625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216268.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21627------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021628
21629Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21630for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21631"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21632retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21633raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21634a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21635file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21636you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21637"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21638
21639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216408.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21641--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021642
21643Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21644multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21645them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21646"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21647logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21648error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21649and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21650too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21651useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21652alternative.
21653
21654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216558.4. Timing events
21656------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021657
21658Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21659reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21660the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21661frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021662mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21663addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21664
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021665Timings events in HTTP mode:
21666
21667 first request 2nd request
21668 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21669 t tr t tr ...
21670 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21671 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21672 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21673 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021674 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021675 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21676
21677Timings events in TCP mode:
21678
21679 TCP session
21680 |<----------------->|
21681 t t
21682 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21683 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21684 |<------ Tt ------->|
21685
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021686 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021687 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021688 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21689 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21690 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021691 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021692 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21693 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21694 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21695 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021696
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021697 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21698 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21699 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021700 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21701 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21702 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21703 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21704 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21705 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021706
21707 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21708 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21709 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21710 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21711 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21712 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21713 request typed by hand during a test.
21714
21715 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21716 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021717 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021718 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21719 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21720 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21721 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021722
21723 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21724 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21725 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21726 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21727 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21728
21729 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21730 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21731 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21732 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21733 connection never established.
21734
21735 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21736 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21737 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21738 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21739 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21740 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21741 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21742 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21743 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21744 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21745 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21746
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021747 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21748 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21749 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21750 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21751 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21752 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21753
21754 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21755
21756 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21757 "Ta" can never be negative.
21758
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021759 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21760 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021761 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21762 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021763 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021764
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021765 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021766
21767 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021768 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21769 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021770
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021771 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21772 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21773 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21774 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21775 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21776 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21777 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21778 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21779
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021780These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21781protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21782that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021783due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21784"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21785that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021786
21787Most common cases :
21788
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021789 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21790 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21791 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21792 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21793 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021794 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021795 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21796 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21797 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21798 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21799 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021800 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021801
21802 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21803 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21804 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21805 of ms on remote networks.
21806
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021807 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21808 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21809 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021810
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021811 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21812 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021813 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021814 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21815 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21816 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21817 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21818 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21819 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021820
21821Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21822
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021823 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021824 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021825 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021826
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021827 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021828 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21829 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21830
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021831 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021832 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21833 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21834 flags.
21835
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021836 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21837 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021838 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21839 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21840 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21841 the client connection was maintained open.
21842
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021843 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021844 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021845 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021846 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21847
21848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218498.5. Session state at disconnection
21850-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021851
21852TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21853"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
218542-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21855each of which has a special meaning :
21856
21857 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21858 session to terminate :
21859
21860 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21861
21862 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21863 server explicitly refused it.
21864
21865 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21866 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21867 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21868 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021869 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021870
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021871 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021872 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021873
21874 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21875 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21876 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21877 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21878 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21879
21880 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21881 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21882 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21883 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21884 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21885
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021886 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021887 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21888
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021889 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021890 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21891 backup connections when going up.
21892
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021893 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021894
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021895 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21896 send or receive data.
21897
21898 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21899 send or receive data.
21900
21901 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21902 with nothing left in the buffers.
21903
21904 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21905
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021906 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021907 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21908
21909 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21910 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21911 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21912 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21913 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21914
21915 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21916 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21917
21918 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21919 server (HTTP only).
21920
21921 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21922
21923 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21924 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21925 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21926
21927 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21928 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21929 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21930
21931 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21932
21933 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21934 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21935
21936 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21937 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21938 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21939
21940 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21941 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021942 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21943 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021944
21945 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21946 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21947 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21948 another server.
21949
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021950 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021951 server.
21952
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021953 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21954 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21955 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21956 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21957
21958 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21959 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21960 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21961 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21962
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021963 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21964 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21965 "use-server" rule).
21966
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021967 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21968
21969 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21970 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21971
21972 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21973
21974 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21975 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21976 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021978 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21979 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021980 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021981 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21982 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21983
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021984 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21985
21986 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21987 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21988
21989 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21990
21991 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21992
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021993The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21994was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021995helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21996starvation, attacks, etc...
21997
21998The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21999alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22000easier finding and understanding.
22001
22002 Flags Reason
22003
22004 -- Normal termination.
22005
22006 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022007 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22008 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022009 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22010
22011 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22012 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022013 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22014 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022015 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22016 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022017
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022018 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22019 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022020 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022021
22022 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22023 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22024 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22025
22026 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22027 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22028 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22029 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22030 the server takes too long to respond.
22031
22032 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22033 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22034 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22035 long a time to respond.
22036
22037 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22038 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22039 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022040 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022041 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22042 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022043
22044 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22045 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22046 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22047 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22048 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022049 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022050 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22051 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22052 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22053 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22054 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22055 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22056 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22057 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022058 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022059 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22060 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22061 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022062
22063 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22064 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022065 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22066 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22067 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22068 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022069
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022070 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022071 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22072
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022073 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022074 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22075 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022076 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022077 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22078 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22079
22080 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22081 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22082 503 or 504 here.
22083
22084 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022085 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022086 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22087 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22088 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22089
22090 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22091 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022092 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022093 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022094 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022095
22096 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22097 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22098 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22099 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22100 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22101 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022102 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022103
22104 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22105 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22106 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22107 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22108 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22109 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22110 solution is to fix the application.
22111
22112 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22113 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22114 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22115 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22116 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22117 external attacks.
22118
22119 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022120 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022121 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022122 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22123 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22124
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022125 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22126 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22127 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022128 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022129 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022131 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22132 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22133 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22134 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022135 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22136 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22137 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22138 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
22139 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022140
22141 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22142 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22143 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
22144 returned an HTTP 403 error.
22145
22146 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22147 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22148 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22149 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22150
22151 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22152 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22153 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22154 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22155
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022156The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022157persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022158important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22159re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22160
22161 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22162
22163 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22164 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22165 set on a GET request.
22166
22167 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22168 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022169 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022170 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22171
22172 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22173 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22174 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22175
22176 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22177 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22178 already got a cookie.
22179
22180 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22181 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22182 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22183 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22184 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22185
22186 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22187 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22188 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22189
22190 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22191 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22192 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22193
22194 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22195 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22196
22197 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22198 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22199 then advertised in the response.
22200
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222028.6. Non-printable characters
22203-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022204
22205In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22206consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22207converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22208prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22209being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22210escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22211is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22212'}' when logging headers.
22213
22214Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22215issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22216containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22217
22218Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22219the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22220performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22221
22222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222238.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22224---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022225
22226Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22227achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022228section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022229cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22230the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22231the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022232locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022233not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22234user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22235a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22236wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22237
22238 Examples :
22239 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22240 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22241
22242 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22243 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22244
22245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222468.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22247---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022248
22249Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22250proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22251the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22252server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22253
22254Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22255response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022256section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022257
22258It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022259time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22260appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022261are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22262and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22263follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22264request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22265in the logs.
22266
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022267As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22268frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22269an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022271 Example :
22272 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22273 listen proxy-out
22274 mode http
22275 option httplog
22276 option logasap
22277 log global
22278 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22279
22280 # log the name of the virtual server
22281 capture request header Host len 20
22282
22283 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22284 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22285
22286 # log the beginning of the referrer
22287 capture request header Referer len 20
22288
22289 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22290 capture response header Server len 20
22291
22292 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22293 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022295 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022296 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22297
22298 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22299 capture response header Via len 20
22300
22301 # log the URL location during a redirection
22302 capture response header Location len 20
22303
22304 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22305 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22306 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22307 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22308 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22309
22310 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22311 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22312 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22313 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022314 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022315
22316 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22317 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22318 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22319 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22320 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022321 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022322
22323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223248.9. Examples of logs
22325---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022326
22327These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22328them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22329reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22330
22331 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22332 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22333 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22334
22335 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22336 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22337
22338 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22339 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22340 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22341
22342 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22343 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22344
22345 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22346 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22347 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22348
22349 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022350 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022351 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22352 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22353
22354 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22355 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22356 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22357
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022358 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22359 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22360 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22361 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022362 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022363 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022364
22365 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022366 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022367
22368 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22369 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22370 Nothing was sent to any server.
22371
22372 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22373 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22374
22375 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22376 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022377 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022378 send a 408 return code to the client.
22379
22380 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22381 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22382
22383 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22384 5 seconds ("c----").
22385
22386 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22387 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022388 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022389
22390 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022391 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022392 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22393 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22394 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22395 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22396 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022397
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022398
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200223999. Supported filters
22400--------------------
22401
22402Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22403accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22404unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22405
22406See also : "filter"
22407
224089.1. Trace
22409----------
22410
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022411filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022412
22413 Arguments:
22414 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22415 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22416
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022417 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022418
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022419 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022420 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22421 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22422 amount of the parsed data.
22423
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022424 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022425
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022426This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22427callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22428information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22429filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22430
22431Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22432tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22433a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22434
22435
224369.2. HTTP compression
22437---------------------
22438
22439filter compression
22440
22441The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22442keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022443when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22444fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22445done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22446explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22447filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22448listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22449order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022450
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022451See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22452 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022453
22454
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200224559.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22456--------------------------------------------
22457
22458filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22459
22460 Arguments :
22461
22462 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22463 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22464 parsed.
22465
22466 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22467 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22468 part must be placed in its own scope.
22469
22470The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22471external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022472streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022473exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22474also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22475
22476SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22477the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22478
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022479For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022480"doc/SPOE.txt".
22481
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100224829.4. Cache
22483----------
22484
22485filter cache <name>
22486
22487 Arguments :
22488
22489 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22490
22491The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22492"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022493cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022494other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22495case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22496is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22497filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022498listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22499order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022500
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022501See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22502 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22503
22504
225059.5. Fcgi-app
22506-------------
22507
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022508filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022509
22510 Arguments :
22511
22512 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22513
22514The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22515request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22516reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22517used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22518implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22519used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22520fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22521used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22522order.
22523
22524See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22525 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22526
22527
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100225289.6. OpenTracing
22529----------------
22530
22531The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22532HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22533of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22534Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22535
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022536This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022537
22538The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22539HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22540participates in the work of HAProxy.
22541
22542filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22543
22544 Arguments :
22545
22546 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22547 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22548 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22549 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22550 OpenTracing filters.
22551
22552 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22553 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22554 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22555 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22556 filter must have its own scope defined.
22557
22558More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022559of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022560
22561
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002256210. FastCGI applications
22563-------------------------
22564
22565HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22566feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22567the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22568FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22569servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22570FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22571backend.
22572
22573HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22574application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22575connection.
22576
2257710.1. Setup
22578-----------
22579
2258010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22581--------------------------
22582
22583fcgi-app <name>
22584 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22585 document root must be defined.
22586
22587acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22588 Declare or complete an access list.
22589
22590 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22591 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22592 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22593 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22594 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22595
22596docroot <path>
22597 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22598 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22599 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22600
22601index <script-name>
22602 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22603 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22604 is an optional setting.
22605
22606 Example :
22607 index index.php
22608
22609log-stderr global
22610log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022611 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022612 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22613
22614 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22615 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22616
22617pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22618 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22619 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22620 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22621
22622 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22623 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22624 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22625 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22626
22627 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22628 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22629
22630path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022631 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022632 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22633 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22634 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22635 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22636 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22637 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22638 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022639
22640 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022641 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022642 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22643 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22644 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22645 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022646
22647 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022648 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22649 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022650
22651option get-values
22652no option get-values
22653 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22654
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022655 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022656 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22657
22658 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22659 application will accept.
22660
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022661 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22662 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022663
22664 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022665 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022666 option is disabled.
22667
22668 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22669 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22670 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22671 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22672 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22673 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22674
22675option keep-conn
22676no option keep-conn
22677 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22678 sending a response.
22679
22680 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22681 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22682
22683option max-reqs <reqs>
22684 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22685 accept.
22686
22687 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22688 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22689 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22690 to 1.
22691
22692option mpxs-conns
22693no option mpxs-conns
22694 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22695
22696 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22697 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22698
22699set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22700 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22701 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22702 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22703 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22704
22705 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22706 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22707 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22708
22709 Example :
22710 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22711 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22712
22713 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22714
22715
2271610.1.2. Proxy section
22717---------------------
22718
22719use-fcgi-app <name>
22720 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22721
22722 Arguments :
22723 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22724
22725 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22726 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22727 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22728 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22729 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22730
22731 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22732 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22733 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22734 application are evaluated.
22735
22736
2273710.1.3. Example
22738---------------
22739
22740 frontend front-http
22741 mode http
22742 bind *:80
22743 bind *:
22744
22745 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22746 default_backend back-static
22747
22748 backend back-static
22749 mode http
22750 server www A.B.C.D:80
22751
22752 backend back-dynamic
22753 mode http
22754 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22755 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22756
22757 fcgi-app php-fpm
22758 log-stderr global
22759 option keep-conn
22760
22761 docroot /var/www/my-app
22762 index index.php
22763 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22764
22765
2276610.2. Default parameters
22767------------------------
22768
22769A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22770the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022771script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022772applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22773
22774 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22775 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22776 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22777 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22778 | | |
22779 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22780 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22781 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22782 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22783 | | application. |
22784 | | |
22785 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22786 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22787 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22788 | | |
22789 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22790 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22791 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22792 | | the application's configuration. |
22793 | | |
22794 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22795 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22796 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22797 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22798 | | |
22799 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22800 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22801 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22802 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22803 | | be defined. |
22804 | | |
22805 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22806 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22807 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22808 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22809 | | is not set too. |
22810 | | |
22811 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22812 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22813 | | set. |
22814 | | |
22815 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22816 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22817 | | the request. |
22818 | | |
22819 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22820 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22821 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22822 | | |
22823 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22824 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22825 | | script to process the request. |
22826 | | |
22827 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22828 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22829 | | |
22830 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22831 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22832 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22833 | | |
22834 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22835 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22836 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22837 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22838 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22839 | | |
22840 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22841 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22842 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22843 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22844 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22845 | | side. |
22846 | | |
22847 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22848 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22849 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22850 | | connected to. |
22851 | | |
22852 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22853 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22854 | | |
22855 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022856 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22857 | | current HAProxy version. |
22858 | | |
22859 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022860 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22861 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22862 | | |
22863 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22864
22865
2286610.3. Limitations
22867------------------
22868
22869The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22870way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22871during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22872establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22873application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22874or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22875message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22876these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22877and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22878
22879Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22880request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22881requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22882
22883About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22884into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22885fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22886"http-request" ones.
22887
22888Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22889FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22890processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22891must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22892here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022893
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022894
2289511. Address formats
22896-------------------
22897
22898Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22899address.
22900
22901This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22902The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22903of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22904equivalent is '::'.
22905
22906Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22907is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22908
22909This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22910family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22911
22912Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22913configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22914use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22915'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22916
22917Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22918socket type and the transport method.
22919
22920
2292111.1 Address family prefixes
22922----------------------------
22923
22924'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22925
22926'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22927 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22928 listening.
22929
22930'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22931 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22932 on the statement using this address, a port or
22933 a port range may or must be specified.
22934
22935'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22936 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22937 using this address, a port or a port range
22938 may or must be specified.
22939
22940'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22941 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22942 using this address, a port or a port range
22943 may or must be specified.
22944
22945'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22946 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22947 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22948 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22949 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22950 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22951
22952'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22953 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22954 start by slash '/'.
22955
22956
2295711.2 Socket type prefixes
22958-------------------------
22959
22960Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22961type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22962this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22963This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22964but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22965
22966Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22967instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22968
22969If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22970they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22971report this to the maintainers.
22972
22973'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22974 to "stream"
22975
22976'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22977 to "datagram".
22978
22979
2298011.3 Protocol prefixes
22981----------------------
22982
22983'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22984 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22985 socket type and transport method is forced to
22986 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22987 this address, a port or a port range can or
22988 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22989 of 'stream+ip@'.
22990
22991'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22992 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22993 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22994 statement using this address, a port or port
22995 range can or must be specified.
22996 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22997
22998'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22999 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23000 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23001 statement using this address, a port or port
23002 range can or must be specified.
23003 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23004
23005'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23006 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23007 socket type and transport method is forced to
23008 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23009 this address, a port or a port range can or
23010 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23011 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23012
23013'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23014 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23015 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23016 the statement using this address, a port or
23017 port range can or must be specified.
23018 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23019
23020'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23021 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23022 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23023 the statement using this address, a port or
23024 port range can or must be specified.
23025 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23026
23027'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23028 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23029 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23030
23031'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23032 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23033 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23034
23035In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23036QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023038/*
23039 * Local variables:
23040 * fill-column: 79
23041 * End:
23042 */